Mercurial > repos > blastem
annotate nuklear_ui/blastem_nuklear.c @ 2370:6bcc2ab01ac6
Fix netplay crash
author | Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com> |
---|---|
date | Mon, 13 Nov 2023 23:37:29 -0800 |
parents | 3e064001594a |
children | 1c09f5be285b |
rev | line source |
---|---|
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
1 #define NK_IMPLEMENTATION |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2 #define NK_SDL_GLES2_IMPLEMENTATION |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
3 #define NK_RAWFB_IMPLEMENTATION |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
4 #define RAWFB_RGBX_8888 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
5 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
6 #include <stdlib.h> |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
7 #include <limits.h> |
1827 | 8 #include <math.h> |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
9 #include "blastem_nuklear.h" |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
10 #include "nuklear_rawfb.h" |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
11 #include "font.h" |
2355
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
12 #include "filechooser.h" |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
13 #include "../render.h" |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
14 #include "../render_sdl.h" |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
15 #include "../util.h" |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
16 #include "../paths.h" |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
17 #include "../saves.h" |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
18 #include "../blastem.h" |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
19 #include "../config.h" |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
20 #include "../io.h" |
1569
0ec89dadb36d
Add code for loading PNG images. Added 360 controller image. WIP work on gamepad mapping UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1568
diff
changeset
|
21 #include "../png.h" |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
22 #include "../controller_info.h" |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
23 #include "../bindings.h" |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
24 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
25 static struct nk_context *context; |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
26 static struct rawfb_context *fb_context; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
27 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
28 typedef struct |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
29 { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
30 uint32_t *image_data; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
31 uint32_t width, height; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
32 struct nk_image ui; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
33 } ui_image; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
34 |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
35 static ui_image **ui_images, *controller_360, *controller_ps4, |
2020
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
36 *controller_ps4_6b, *controller_wiiu, *controller_gen_6b; |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
37 static uint32_t num_ui_images, ui_image_storage; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
38 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
39 typedef void (*view_fun)(struct nk_context *); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
40 static view_fun current_view; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
41 static view_fun *previous_views; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
42 static uint32_t view_storage; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
43 static uint32_t num_prev; |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
44 static struct nk_font *def_font; |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
45 static uint8_t config_dirty; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
46 |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
47 static void push_view(view_fun new_view) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
48 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
49 if (num_prev == view_storage) { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
50 view_storage = view_storage ? 2*view_storage : 2; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
51 previous_views = realloc(previous_views, view_storage*sizeof(view_fun)); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
52 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
53 previous_views[num_prev++] = current_view; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
54 current_view = new_view; |
1841
5d10b8494b02
WIP keyboard nav for Nuklear menus
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1831
diff
changeset
|
55 context->input.selected_widget = 0; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
56 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
57 |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
58 static void pop_view() |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
59 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
60 if (num_prev) { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
61 current_view = previous_views[--num_prev]; |
1841
5d10b8494b02
WIP keyboard nav for Nuklear menus
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1831
diff
changeset
|
62 context->input.selected_widget = 0; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
63 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
64 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
65 |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
66 static void clear_view_stack() |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
67 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
68 num_prev = 0; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
69 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
70 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
71 void view_play(struct nk_context *context) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
72 { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
73 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
74 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
75 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
76 static char *browser_cur_path; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
77 static const char *browser_label; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
78 static const char *browser_setting_path; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
79 static const char **browser_ext_list; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
80 static uint32_t browser_num_exts; |
2355
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
81 static uint8_t use_native_filechooser; |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
82 |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
83 static void handle_chooser_result(uint8_t normal_open, char *full_path) |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
84 { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
85 if(normal_open) { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
86 if (current_system) { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
87 current_system->next_rom = full_path; |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
88 current_system->request_exit(current_system); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
89 } else { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
90 init_system_with_media(full_path, SYSTEM_UNKNOWN); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
91 free(full_path); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
92 } |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
93 |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
94 clear_view_stack(); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
95 show_play_view(); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
96 } else if (browser_setting_path) { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
97 config = tern_insert_path(config, browser_setting_path, (tern_val){.ptrval = full_path}, TVAL_PTR); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
98 config_dirty = 1; |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
99 browser_ext_list = NULL; |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
100 pop_view(); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
101 } else { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
102 lockon_media(full_path); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
103 free(full_path); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
104 |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
105 clear_view_stack(); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
106 show_play_view(); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
107 } |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
108 } |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
109 |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
110 void view_file_browser(struct nk_context *context, uint8_t normal_open) |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
111 { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
112 static dir_entry *entries; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
113 static size_t num_entries; |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
114 static int32_t selected_entry = -1; |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
115 static const char **ext_list; |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
116 static uint32_t num_exts; |
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
117 static uint8_t got_ext_list; |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
118 if (!browser_cur_path) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
119 get_initial_browse_path(&browser_cur_path); |
1481
77a401044935
Fix directory navigation in ROM file chooser in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1478
diff
changeset
|
120 } |
2355
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
121 if (use_native_filechooser && native_filechooser_available()) { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
122 char *path = native_filechooser_pick(browser_label, browser_cur_path); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
123 if (path) { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
124 free(browser_cur_path); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
125 browser_cur_path = path_dirname(path); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
126 handle_chooser_result(normal_open, path); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
127 } else { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
128 browser_ext_list = NULL; |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
129 pop_view(); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
130 } |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
131 return; |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
132 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
133 if (!entries) { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
134 entries = get_dir_list(browser_cur_path, &num_entries); |
1484
d82af64c94d2
Sort directory listing in Nuklear UI file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1483
diff
changeset
|
135 if (entries) { |
d82af64c94d2
Sort directory listing in Nuklear UI file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1483
diff
changeset
|
136 sort_dir_list(entries, num_entries); |
d82af64c94d2
Sort directory listing in Nuklear UI file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1483
diff
changeset
|
137 } |
2017
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
138 if (!num_entries) { |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
139 //get_dir_list can fail if the user doesn't have permission |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
140 //for the current folder, make sure they can still navigate up |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
141 free_dir_list(entries, num_entries); |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
142 entries = calloc(1, sizeof(dir_entry)); |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
143 entries[0].name = strdup(".."); |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
144 entries[0].is_dir = 1; |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
145 num_entries = 1; |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
146 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
147 } |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
148 if (!browser_ext_list) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
149 if (!got_ext_list) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
150 ext_list = (const char **)get_extension_list(config, &num_exts); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
151 got_ext_list = 1; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
152 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
153 browser_ext_list = ext_list; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
154 browser_num_exts = num_exts; |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
155 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
156 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
157 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
158 if (nk_begin(context, "Load ROM", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
159 nk_layout_row_static(context, height - context->style.font->height * 3, width - 60, 1); |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
160 int32_t old_selected = selected_entry; |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
161 const char *parts[] = {browser_label, ": ", browser_cur_path}; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
162 char *title = alloc_concat_m(3, parts); |
2016
2d8748e0ccb2
Show current path in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2015
diff
changeset
|
163 if (nk_group_begin(context, title, NK_WINDOW_BORDER | NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
164 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height - 2, width-100, 1); |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
165 for (int32_t i = 0; i < num_entries; i++) |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
166 { |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
167 if (entries[i].name[0] == '.' && entries[i].name[1] != '.') { |
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
168 continue; |
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
169 } |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
170 if (browser_num_exts && !entries[i].is_dir && !path_matches_extensions(entries[i].name, browser_ext_list, browser_num_exts)) { |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
171 continue; |
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
172 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
173 int selected = i == selected_entry; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
174 nk_selectable_label(context, entries[i].name, NK_TEXT_ALIGN_LEFT, &selected); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
175 if (selected) { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
176 selected_entry = i; |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
177 } else if (i == selected_entry) { |
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
178 selected_entry = -1; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
179 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
180 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
181 nk_group_end(context); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
182 } |
2016
2d8748e0ccb2
Show current path in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2015
diff
changeset
|
183 free(title); |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
184 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.75, width > 600 ? 300 : width / 2, 2); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
185 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
186 browser_ext_list = NULL; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
187 pop_view(); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
188 } |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
189 if (nk_button_label(context, "Open") || (old_selected >= 0 && selected_entry < 0)) { |
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
190 if (selected_entry < 0) { |
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
191 selected_entry = old_selected; |
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
192 } |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
193 char *full_path = path_append(browser_cur_path, entries[selected_entry].name); |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
194 if (entries[selected_entry].is_dir) { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
195 free(browser_cur_path); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
196 browser_cur_path = full_path; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
197 free_dir_list(entries, num_entries); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
198 entries = NULL; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
199 } else { |
2355
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
200 handle_chooser_result(normal_open, full_path); |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
201 } |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
202 selected_entry = -1; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
203 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
204 nk_end(context); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
205 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
206 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
207 |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
208 void view_load(struct nk_context *context) |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
209 { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
210 browser_label = "Select ROM"; |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
211 view_file_browser(context, 1); |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
212 } |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
213 |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
214 void view_lock_on(struct nk_context *context) |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
215 { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
216 browser_label = "Select ROM"; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
217 view_file_browser(context, 0); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
218 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
219 |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
220 void view_file_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
221 { |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
222 view_file_browser(context, 0); |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
223 } |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
224 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
225 void view_about(struct nk_context *context) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
226 { |
1526 | 227 const char *lines[] = { |
1815
7f4fac75b484
Update version number for nightly builds
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1814
diff
changeset
|
228 "BlastEm v0.6.3-pre", |
1812
8aeac7bd9fa7
Update version number, special thanks, CHANGELOG and README in preparation for possible 0.6.2 release
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1811
diff
changeset
|
229 "Copyright 2012-2019 Michael Pavone", |
1526 | 230 "", |
231 "BlastEm is a high performance open source", | |
232 "(GPLv3) Genesis/Megadrive emulator", | |
233 }; | |
234 const uint32_t NUM_LINES = sizeof(lines)/sizeof(*lines); | |
235 const char *thanks[] = { | |
1661 | 236 "Nemesis: Documentation and test ROMs", |
1526 | 237 "Charles MacDonald: Documentation", |
238 "Eke-Eke: Documentation", | |
1812
8aeac7bd9fa7
Update version number, special thanks, CHANGELOG and README in preparation for possible 0.6.2 release
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1811
diff
changeset
|
239 "Sauraen: YM2612/YM2203 Die Analysis", |
8aeac7bd9fa7
Update version number, special thanks, CHANGELOG and README in preparation for possible 0.6.2 release
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1811
diff
changeset
|
240 "Alexey Khokholov: YM3438 Die Analysis", |
1526 | 241 "Bart Trzynadlowski: Documentation", |
242 "KanedaFR: Hosting the best Sega forum", | |
243 "Titan: Awesome demos and documentation", | |
1661 | 244 "flamewing: BCD info and test ROM", |
245 "r57shell: Opcode size test ROM", | |
1526 | 246 "micky: Testing", |
247 "Sasha: Testing", | |
248 "lol-frank: Testing", | |
249 "Sik: Testing", | |
250 "Tim Lawrence : Testing", | |
251 "ComradeOj: Testing", | |
252 "Vladikcomper: Testing" | |
253 }; | |
254 const uint32_t NUM_THANKS = sizeof(thanks)/sizeof(*thanks); | |
255 uint32_t width = render_width(); | |
256 uint32_t height = render_height(); | |
257 if (nk_begin(context, "About", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { | |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
258 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, width-40, 1); |
1526 | 259 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < NUM_LINES; i++) |
260 { | |
261 nk_label(context, lines[i], NK_TEXT_LEFT); | |
262 } | |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
263 nk_layout_row_static(context, height - (context->style.font->height * 2 + 20) - (context->style.font->height +4)*NUM_LINES, width-40, 1); |
1526 | 264 if (nk_group_begin(context, "Special Thanks", NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
265 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, width - 80, 1); |
1526 | 266 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < NUM_THANKS; i++) |
267 { | |
268 nk_label(context, thanks[i], NK_TEXT_LEFT); | |
269 } | |
270 nk_group_end(context); | |
271 } | |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
272 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.75, width/3, 1); |
1526 | 273 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
274 pop_view(); | |
275 } | |
276 nk_end(context); | |
277 } | |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
278 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
279 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
280 typedef struct { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
281 const char *title; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
282 view_fun next_view; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
283 } menu_item; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
284 |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
285 static save_slot_info *slots; |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
286 static uint32_t num_slots, selected_slot; |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
287 |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
288 void view_choose_state(struct nk_context *context, uint8_t is_load) |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
289 { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
290 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
291 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
292 if (nk_begin(context, "Slot Picker", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
293 nk_layout_row_static(context, height - context->style.font->height * 3, width - 60, 1); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
294 if (nk_group_begin(context, "Select Save Slot", NK_WINDOW_BORDER | NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
295 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height - 2, width-100, 1); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
296 if (!slots) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
297 slots = get_slot_info(current_system, &num_slots); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
298 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
299 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_slots; i++) |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
300 { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
301 int selected = i == selected_slot; |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
302 nk_selectable_label(context, slots[i].desc, NK_TEXT_ALIGN_LEFT, &selected); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
303 if (selected && (slots[i].modification_time || !is_load)) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
304 selected_slot = i; |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
305 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
306 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
307 nk_group_end(context); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
308 } |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
309 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.75, width > 600 ? 300 : width / 2, 2); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
310 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
311 pop_view(); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
312 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
313 if (is_load) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
314 if (nk_button_label(context, "Load")) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
315 current_system->load_state(current_system, selected_slot); |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
316 show_play_view(); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
317 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
318 } else { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
319 if (nk_button_label(context, "Save")) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
320 current_system->save_state = selected_slot + 1; |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
321 show_play_view(); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
322 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
323 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
324 nk_end(context); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
325 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
326 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
327 |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
328 void view_save_state(struct nk_context *context) |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
329 { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
330 view_choose_state(context, 0); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
331 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
332 |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
333 void view_load_state(struct nk_context *context) |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
334 { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
335 view_choose_state(context, 1); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
336 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
337 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
338 typedef void (*menu_handler)(uint32_t index); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
339 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
340 static void menu(struct nk_context *context, uint32_t num_entries, const menu_item *items, menu_handler handler) |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
341 { |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
342 const uint32_t button_height = context->style.font->height * 1.75; |
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
343 const uint32_t ideal_button_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
344 const uint32_t button_space = 6; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
345 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
346 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
347 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
348 uint32_t top = height/2 - (button_height * num_entries)/2; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
349 uint32_t button_width = width > ideal_button_width ? ideal_button_width : width; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
350 uint32_t left = width/2 - button_width/2; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
351 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
352 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, top + button_height * num_entries, num_entries); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
353 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_entries; i++) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
354 { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
355 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(left, top + i * button_height, button_width, button_height-button_space)); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
356 if (nk_button_label(context, items[i].title)) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
357 if (items[i].next_view) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
358 push_view(items[i].next_view); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
359 if (current_view == view_save_state || current_view == view_load_state) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
360 free_slot_info(slots); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
361 slots = NULL; |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
362 } else if (current_view == view_play) { |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
363 clear_view_stack(); |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
364 set_content_binding_state(1); |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
365 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
366 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
367 handler(i); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
368 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
369 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
370 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
371 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
372 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
373 |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
374 void binding_loop(char *key, tern_val val, uint8_t valtype, void *data) |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
375 { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
376 if (valtype != TVAL_PTR) { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
377 return; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
378 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
379 tern_node **binding_lookup = data; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
380 *binding_lookup = tern_insert_ptr(*binding_lookup, val.ptrval, strdup(key)); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
381 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
382 |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
383 static int32_t keycode; |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
384 static const char *set_binding; |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
385 static uint8_t bind_click_release, click; |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
386 char *set_label; |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
387 void binding_group(struct nk_context *context, char *name, const char **binds, const char **bind_names, uint32_t num_binds, tern_node *binding_lookup) |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
388 { |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
389 nk_layout_row_static(context, (context->style.font->height + 4)*num_binds+context->style.font->height+30, render_width() - 80, 1); |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
390 if (nk_group_begin(context, name, NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
391 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, render_width()/2 - 80, 2); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
392 |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
393 for (int i = 0; i < num_binds; i++) |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
394 { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
395 char *label_alloc = bind_names ? NULL : path_extension(binds[i]); |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
396 const char *label = label_alloc; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
397 if (!label) { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
398 label = bind_names ? bind_names[i] : binds[i]; |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
399 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
400 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
401 if (nk_button_label(context, tern_find_ptr_default(binding_lookup, binds[i], "Not Set"))) { |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
402 set_binding = binds[i]; |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
403 set_label = strdup(label); |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
404 bind_click_release = 0; |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
405 keycode = 0; |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
406 } |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
407 if (label_alloc) { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
408 free(label_alloc); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
409 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
410 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
411 nk_group_end(context); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
412 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
413 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
414 |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
415 static char *get_key_name(int32_t keycode) |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
416 { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
417 char *name = NULL; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
418 if (keycode > ' ' && keycode < 0x80) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
419 //key corresponds to a printable non-whitespace character |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
420 name = malloc(2); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
421 name[0] = keycode; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
422 name[1] = 0; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
423 } else { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
424 switch (keycode) |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
425 { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
426 case RENDERKEY_UP: name = "up"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
427 case RENDERKEY_DOWN: name = "down"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
428 case RENDERKEY_LEFT: name = "left"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
429 case RENDERKEY_RIGHT: name = "right"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
430 case '\r': name = "enter"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
431 case ' ': name = "space"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
432 case '\t': name = "tab"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
433 case '\b': name = "backspace"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
434 case RENDERKEY_ESC: name = "esc"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
435 case RENDERKEY_DEL: name = "delete"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
436 case RENDERKEY_LSHIFT: name = "lshift"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
437 case RENDERKEY_RSHIFT: name = "rshift"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
438 case RENDERKEY_LCTRL: name = "lctrl"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
439 case RENDERKEY_RCTRL: name = "rctrl"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
440 case RENDERKEY_LALT: name = "lalt"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
441 case RENDERKEY_RALT: name = "ralt"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
442 case RENDERKEY_HOME: name = "home"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
443 case RENDERKEY_END: name = "end"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
444 case RENDERKEY_PAGEUP: name = "pageup"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
445 case RENDERKEY_PAGEDOWN: name = "pagedown"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
446 case RENDERKEY_F1: name = "f1"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
447 case RENDERKEY_F2: name = "f2"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
448 case RENDERKEY_F3: name = "f3"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
449 case RENDERKEY_F4: name = "f4"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
450 case RENDERKEY_F5: name = "f5"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
451 case RENDERKEY_F6: name = "f6"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
452 case RENDERKEY_F7: name = "f7"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
453 case RENDERKEY_F8: name = "f8"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
454 case RENDERKEY_F9: name = "f9"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
455 case RENDERKEY_F10: name = "f10"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
456 case RENDERKEY_F11: name = "f11"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
457 case RENDERKEY_F12: name = "f12"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
458 case RENDERKEY_SELECT: name = "select"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
459 case RENDERKEY_PLAY: name = "play"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
460 case RENDERKEY_SEARCH: name = "search"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
461 case RENDERKEY_BACK: name = "back"; break; |
1549
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
462 case RENDERKEY_NP0: name = "np0"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
463 case RENDERKEY_NP1: name = "np1"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
464 case RENDERKEY_NP2: name = "np2"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
465 case RENDERKEY_NP3: name = "np3"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
466 case RENDERKEY_NP4: name = "np4"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
467 case RENDERKEY_NP5: name = "np5"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
468 case RENDERKEY_NP6: name = "np6"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
469 case RENDERKEY_NP7: name = "np7"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
470 case RENDERKEY_NP8: name = "np8"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
471 case RENDERKEY_NP9: name = "np9"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
472 case RENDERKEY_NP_DIV: name = "np/"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
473 case RENDERKEY_NP_MUL: name = "np*"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
474 case RENDERKEY_NP_MIN: name = "np-"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
475 case RENDERKEY_NP_PLUS: name = "np+"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
476 case RENDERKEY_NP_ENTER: name = "npenter"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
477 case RENDERKEY_NP_STOP: name = "np."; break; |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
478 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
479 if (name) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
480 name = strdup(name); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
481 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
482 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
483 return name; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
484 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
485 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
486 void view_key_bindings(struct nk_context *context) |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
487 { |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
488 static const char *controller1_binds[] = { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
489 "gamepads.1.up", "gamepads.1.down", "gamepads.1.left", "gamepads.1.right", |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
490 "gamepads.1.a", "gamepads.1.b", "gamepads.1.c", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
491 "gamepads.1.x", "gamepads.1.y", "gamepads.1.z", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
492 "gamepads.1.start", "gamepads.1.mode" |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
493 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
494 static const char *controller2_binds[] = { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
495 "gamepads.2.up", "gamepads.2.down", "gamepads.2.left", "gamepads.2.right", |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
496 "gamepads.2.a", "gamepads.2.b", "gamepads.2.c", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
497 "gamepads.2.x", "gamepads.2.y", "gamepads.2.z", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
498 "gamepads.2.start", "gamepads.2.mode" |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
499 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
500 static const char *general_binds[] = { |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
501 "ui.menu", "ui.save_state", "ui.load_state", "ui.toggle_fullscreen", "ui.soft_reset", "ui.reload", |
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
502 "ui.screenshot", "ui.vgm_log", "ui.sms_pause", "ui.toggle_keyboard_captured", "ui.release_mouse", "ui.exit" |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
503 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
504 static const char *general_names[] = { |
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
505 "Show Menu", "Quick Save", "Quick Load", "Toggle Fullscreen", "Soft Reset", "Reload Media", |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
506 "Internal Screenshot", "Toggle VGM Log", "SMS Pause", "Capture Keyboard", "Release Mouse", "Exit" |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
507 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
508 static const char *speed_binds[] = { |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
509 "ui.next_speed", "ui.prev_speed", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
510 "ui.set_speed.0", "ui.set_speed.1", "ui.set_speed.2" ,"ui.set_speed.3", "ui.set_speed.4", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
511 "ui.set_speed.5", "ui.set_speed.6", "ui.set_speed.7" ,"ui.set_speed.8", "ui.set_speed.9", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
512 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
513 static const char *speed_names[] = { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
514 "Next", "Previous", |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
515 "Default Speed", "Set Speed 1", "Set Speed 2", "Set Speed 3", "Set Speed 4", |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
516 "Set Speed 5", "Set Speed 6", "Set Speed 7", "Set Speed 8", "Set Speed 9" |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
517 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
518 static const char *debug_binds[] = { |
1660
c6cc2dae262f
Updated binding UI to reflect new VDP debug options
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1658
diff
changeset
|
519 "ui.enter_debugger", "ui.plane_debug", "ui.vram_debug", "ui.cram_debug", |
c6cc2dae262f
Updated binding UI to reflect new VDP debug options
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1658
diff
changeset
|
520 "ui.compositing_debug", "ui.vdp_debug_mode" |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
521 }; |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
522 const char *debug_names[] = { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
523 "CPU Debugger", "Plane Debugger", "VRAM Debugger", "CRAM Debugger", |
1660
c6cc2dae262f
Updated binding UI to reflect new VDP debug options
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1658
diff
changeset
|
524 "Layer Debugger", "Cycle Mode/Pal" |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
525 }; |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
526 const uint32_t NUM_C1_BINDS = sizeof(controller1_binds)/sizeof(*controller1_binds); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
527 const uint32_t NUM_C2_BINDS = sizeof(controller2_binds)/sizeof(*controller2_binds); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
528 const uint32_t NUM_SPEED_BINDS = sizeof(speed_binds)/sizeof(*speed_binds); |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
529 const uint32_t NUM_GEN_BINDS = sizeof(general_binds)/sizeof(*general_binds); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
530 const uint32_t NUM_DBG_BINDS = sizeof(debug_binds)/sizeof(*debug_binds); |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
531 static tern_node *binding_lookup; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
532 if (!binding_lookup) { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
533 tern_node *bindings = tern_find_path(config, "bindings\0keys\0", TVAL_NODE).ptrval; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
534 if (bindings) { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
535 tern_foreach(bindings, binding_loop, &binding_lookup); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
536 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
537 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
538 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
539 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
540 if (nk_begin(context, "Keyboard Bindings", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
541 binding_group(context, "Controller 1", controller1_binds, NULL, NUM_C1_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
542 binding_group(context, "Controller 2", controller2_binds, NULL, NUM_C2_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
543 binding_group(context, "General", general_binds, general_names, NUM_GEN_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
544 binding_group(context, "Speed Control", speed_binds, speed_names, NUM_SPEED_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
545 binding_group(context, "Debug", debug_binds, debug_names, NUM_DBG_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
546 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.1333, (render_width() - 80) / 2, 1); |
1545
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
547 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
548 pop_view(); |
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
549 } |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
550 nk_end(context); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
551 } |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
552 if (set_binding && nk_begin(context, "Set Binding", nk_rect(width/4, height/4, width/2/*width*3/4*/, height/2), NK_WINDOW_TITLE | NK_WINDOW_BORDER)) { |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
553 nk_layout_row_static(context, 30, width/2-30, 1); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
554 nk_label(context, "Press new key for", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
555 nk_label(context, set_label, NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
556 if (nk_button_label(context, "Cancel") && bind_click_release) { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
557 free(set_label); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
558 set_binding = set_label = NULL; |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
559 } else if (keycode) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
560 char *name = get_key_name(keycode); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
561 if (name) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
562 uint32_t prefix_len = strlen("bindings") + strlen("keys") + 2; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
563 char * old = tern_find_ptr(binding_lookup, set_binding); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
564 if (old) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
565 uint32_t suffix_len = strlen(old) + 1; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
566 char *old_path = malloc(prefix_len + suffix_len + 1); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
567 memcpy(old_path, "bindings\0keys\0", prefix_len); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
568 memcpy(old_path + prefix_len, old, suffix_len); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
569 old_path[prefix_len + suffix_len] = 0; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
570 tern_val old_val; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
571 if (tern_delete_path(&config, old_path, &old_val) == TVAL_PTR) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
572 free(old_val.ptrval); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
573 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
574 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
575 uint32_t suffix_len = strlen(name) + 1; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
576 char *path = malloc(prefix_len + suffix_len + 1); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
577 memcpy(path, "bindings\0keys\0", prefix_len); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
578 memcpy(path + prefix_len, name, suffix_len); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
579 path[prefix_len + suffix_len] = 0; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
580 |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
581 config_dirty = 1; |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
582 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(set_binding)}, TVAL_PTR); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
583 free(path); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
584 free(name); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
585 tern_free(binding_lookup); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
586 binding_lookup = NULL; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
587 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
588 free(set_label); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
589 set_binding = set_label = NULL; |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
590 } else if (!click) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
591 bind_click_release = 1; |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
592 } |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
593 nk_end(context); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
594 } |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
595 } |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
596 |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
597 static int selected_controller; |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
598 static controller_info selected_controller_info; |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
599 //#define MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH 140 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
600 #define MAX_BIND_BOX_WIDTH 350 |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
601 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
602 #define AXIS 0x40000000 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
603 #define STICKDIR 0x30000000 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
604 #define LEFTSTICK 0x10000000 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
605 #define RIGHTSTICK 0x20000000 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
606 enum { |
2310
b0ec82a59472
Fix analog stick directions being messed up in controller binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2308
diff
changeset
|
607 DOWN, UP,RIGHT,LEFT,NUM_AXIS_DIRS |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
608 }; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
609 |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
610 static char * config_ps_names[] = { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
611 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A] = "cross", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
612 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B] = "circle", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
613 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_X] = "square", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
614 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_Y] = "triangle", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
615 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_BACK] = "share", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
616 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_START] = "options", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
617 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER] = "l1", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
618 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER] = "r1", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
619 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSTICK] = "l3", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
620 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSTICK] = "r3", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
621 }; |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
622 |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
623 typedef struct { |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
624 const char *button_binds[SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX]; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
625 const char *left_stick[NUM_AXIS_DIRS]; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
626 const char *right_stick[NUM_AXIS_DIRS]; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
627 const char *triggers[2]; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
628 } pad_bind_config; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
629 |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
630 static const char **current_bind_dest; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
631 |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
632 const char *translate_binding_option(const char *option) |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
633 { |
1625
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
634 static tern_node *conf_names; |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
635 if (!conf_names) { |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
636 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.up", "Pad Up"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
637 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.down", "Pad Down"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
638 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.left", "Pad Left"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
639 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.right", "Pad Right"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
640 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.a", "Pad A"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
641 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.b", "Pad B"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
642 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.c", "Pad C"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
643 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.x", "Pad X"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
644 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.y", "Pad Y"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
645 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.z", "Pad Z"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
646 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.start", "Pad Start"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
647 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.mode", "Pad Mode"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
648 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.release_mouse", "Release Mouse"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
649 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.vdp_debug_mode", "VDP Debug Mode"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
650 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.vdp_debug_pal", "VDP Debug Palette"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
651 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.enter_debugger", "Enter CPU Debugger"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
652 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.screenshot", "Take Screenshot"); |
1910
ee178f08611b
Expose vgm toggle keybind in settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1900
diff
changeset
|
653 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.vgm_log", "Toggle VGM Log"); |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
654 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.menu", "Show Menu"); |
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
655 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.exit", "Exit"); |
1625
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
656 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.save_state", "Quick Save"); |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
657 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.load_state", "Quick Load"); |
1625
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
658 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.0", "Set Speed 0"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
659 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.1", "Set Speed 1"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
660 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.2", "Set Speed 2"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
661 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.3", "Set Speed 3"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
662 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.4", "Set Speed 4"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
663 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.5", "Set Speed 5"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
664 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.6", "Set Speed 6"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
665 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.7", "Set Speed 7"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
666 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.8", "Set Speed 8"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
667 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.9", "Set Speed 9"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
668 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.next_speed", "Next Speed"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
669 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.prev_speed", "Prev. Speed"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
670 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.toggle_fullscreen", "Toggle Fullscreen"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
671 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.soft_reset", "Soft Reset"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
672 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.reload", "Reload ROM"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
673 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.sms_pause", "SMS Pause"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
674 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.toggle_keyboard_captured", "Toggle Keyboard Capture"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
675 } |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
676 return tern_find_ptr_default(conf_names, option, (void *)option); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
677 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
678 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
679 static uint8_t controller_binding_changed; |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
680 static void bind_option_group(struct nk_context *context, char *name, const char **options, uint32_t num_options) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
681 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
682 float margin = context->style.font->height * 2; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
683 nk_layout_row_static(context, (context->style.font->height + 3) * ((num_options + 2) / 3) + context->style.font->height*2.1, render_width() - margin, 1); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
684 if (nk_group_begin(context, name, NK_WINDOW_TITLE|NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
685 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, (render_width() - margin - context->style.font->height) / 3, 3); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
686 for (int i = 0; i < num_options; i++) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
687 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
688 if (nk_button_label(context, translate_binding_option(options[i]))) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
689 *current_bind_dest = options[i]; |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
690 controller_binding_changed = 1; |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
691 pop_view(); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
692 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
693 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
694 nk_group_end(context); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
695 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
696 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
697 |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
698 static void view_button_binding(struct nk_context *context) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
699 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
700 static const char *pad_opts[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
701 "gamepads.n.up", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
702 "gamepads.n.down", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
703 "gamepads.n.left", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
704 "gamepads.n.right", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
705 "gamepads.n.a", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
706 "gamepads.n.b", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
707 "gamepads.n.c", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
708 "gamepads.n.x", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
709 "gamepads.n.y", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
710 "gamepads.n.z", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
711 "gamepads.n.start", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
712 "gamepads.n.mode" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
713 }; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
714 static const char *system_buttons[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
715 "ui.soft_reset", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
716 "ui.reload", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
717 "ui.sms_pause" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
718 }; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
719 static const char *emu_control[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
720 "ui.save_state", |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
721 "ui.load_state", |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
722 "ui.menu", |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
723 "ui.toggle_fullscreen", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
724 "ui.screenshot", |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
725 "ui.exit", |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
726 "ui.release_mouse", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
727 "ui.toggle_keyboard_captured" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
728 }; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
729 static const char *debugger[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
730 "ui.vdp_debug_mode", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
731 "ui.vdp_debug_pal", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
732 "ui.enter_debugger" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
733 }; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
734 static const char *speeds[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
735 "ui.next_speed", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
736 "ui.prev_speed", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
737 "ui.set_speed.0", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
738 "ui.set_speed.1", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
739 "ui.set_speed.2", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
740 "ui.set_speed.3", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
741 "ui.set_speed.4", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
742 "ui.set_speed.5", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
743 "ui.set_speed.6", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
744 "ui.set_speed.7", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
745 "ui.set_speed.8", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
746 "ui.set_speed.9" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
747 }; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
748 |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
749 if (nk_begin(context, "Button Binding", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
750 bind_option_group(context, "Controller Buttons", pad_opts, sizeof(pad_opts)/sizeof(*pad_opts)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
751 bind_option_group(context, "System Buttons", system_buttons, sizeof(system_buttons)/sizeof(*system_buttons)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
752 bind_option_group(context, "Emulator Control", emu_control, sizeof(emu_control)/sizeof(*emu_control)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
753 bind_option_group(context, "Debugging", debugger, sizeof(debugger)/sizeof(*debugger)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
754 bind_option_group(context, "Speed Control", speeds, sizeof(speeds)/sizeof(*speeds)); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
755 |
2311
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
756 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, (render_width() - 80)/4, 2); |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
757 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
758 pop_view(); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
759 } |
2311
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
760 if (nk_button_label(context, "Clear")) { |
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
761 *current_bind_dest = NULL; |
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
762 controller_binding_changed = 1; |
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
763 pop_view(); |
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
764 } |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
765 nk_end(context); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
766 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
767 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
768 |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
769 static void binding_box(struct nk_context *context, pad_bind_config *bindings, char *name, float x, float y, float width, int num_binds, int *binds) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
770 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
771 const struct nk_user_font *font = context->style.font; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
772 float row_height = font->height * 2; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
773 |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
774 char const **labels = calloc(sizeof(char *), num_binds); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
775 char const ***conf_vals = calloc(sizeof(char *), num_binds); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
776 float max_width = 0.0f; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
777 |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
778 int skipped = 0; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
779 for (int i = 0; i < num_binds; i++) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
780 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
781 if (binds[i] & AXIS) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
782 labels[i] = get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, binds[i] & ~AXIS); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
783 conf_vals[i] = &bindings->triggers[(binds[i] & ~AXIS) - SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
784 } else if (binds[i] & STICKDIR) { |
2311
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
785 static char const * dirs[] = {"Down", "Up", "Right", "Left"}; |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
786 labels[i] = dirs[binds[i] & 3]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
787 conf_vals[i] = &(binds[i] & LEFTSTICK ? bindings->left_stick : bindings->right_stick)[binds[i] & 3]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
788 } else { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
789 labels[i] = get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, binds[i]); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
790 conf_vals[i] = &bindings->button_binds[binds[i]]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
791 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
792 if (!labels[i]) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
793 skipped++; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
794 continue; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
795 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
796 float lb_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, labels[i], strlen(labels[i])); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
797 max_width = max_width < lb_width ? lb_width : max_width; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
798 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
799 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(x, y, width, (num_binds - skipped) * (row_height + 4) + 4)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
800 nk_group_begin(context, name, NK_WINDOW_BORDER | NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
801 |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
802 float widths[] = {max_width + 3, width - (max_width + 6)}; |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
803 nk_layout_row(context, NK_STATIC, row_height, 2, widths); |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
804 for (int i = 0; i < num_binds; i++) |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
805 { |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
806 if (!labels[i]) { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
807 continue; |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
808 } |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
809 nk_label(context, labels[i], NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
810 const char *name = *conf_vals[i] ? translate_binding_option(*conf_vals[i]) : "None"; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
811 if (nk_button_label(context, name)) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
812 current_bind_dest = conf_vals[i]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
813 push_view(view_button_binding); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
814 } |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
815 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
816 free(labels); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
817 free(conf_vals); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
818 nk_group_end(context); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
819 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
820 |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
821 static void button_iter(char *key, tern_val val, uint8_t valtype, void *data) |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
822 { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
823 pad_bind_config *bindings = data; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
824 if (valtype != TVAL_PTR) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
825 return; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
826 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
827 int button = render_lookup_button(key); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
828 if (button != SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_INVALID) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
829 bindings->button_binds[button] = val.ptrval; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
830 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
831 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
832 |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
833 static void axis_iter(char *key, tern_val val, uint8_t valtype, void *data) |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
834 { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
835 pad_bind_config *bindings = data; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
836 if (valtype != TVAL_PTR) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
837 return; |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
838 } |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
839 int axis; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
840 uint8_t is_negative = 0; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
841 char *period = strchr(key, '.'); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
842 if (period) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
843 char *tmp = malloc(period-key + 1); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
844 memcpy(tmp, key, period-key); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
845 tmp[period-key] = 0; |
1624
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
846 axis = render_lookup_axis(tmp); |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
847 free(tmp); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
848 is_negative = strcmp(period+1, "negative") == 0; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
849 } else { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
850 axis = render_lookup_axis(key); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
851 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
852 switch (axis) |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
853 { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
854 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTX: |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
855 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTY: |
2311
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
856 bindings->left_stick[(SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTY - axis) * 2 + is_negative] = val.ptrval; |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
857 break; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
858 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_RIGHTX: |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
859 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_RIGHTY: |
2313
ef5dc4d02d27
Fix goof in right analog stick mapping UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2312
diff
changeset
|
860 bindings->right_stick[(SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_RIGHTY - axis) * 2 + is_negative] = val.ptrval; |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
861 break; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
862 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT: |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
863 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT: |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
864 bindings->triggers[axis-SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT] = val.ptrval; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
865 break; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
866 } |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
867 } |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
868 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
869 enum { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
870 SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
871 IDENTICAL_CONTROLLERS, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
872 BY_INDEX, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
873 DEFAULT, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
874 NUM_DEST_TYPES |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
875 }; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
876 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
877 //it would be cleaner to generate this algorithmically for 4th and up, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
878 //but BlastEm only supports 8 controllers currently so it's not worth the effort |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
879 static const char *by_index_names[] = { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
880 "Use for 1st controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
881 "Use for 2nd controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
882 "Use for 3rd controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
883 "Use for 4th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
884 "Use for 5th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
885 "Use for 6th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
886 "Use for 7th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
887 "Use for 8th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
888 }; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
889 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
890 static void save_stick_binds(char *axes_key, size_t axes_key_size, const char **bindings, char *prefix) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
891 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
892 for (int i = 0; i < NUM_AXIS_DIRS; i++) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
893 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
894 char axis = (i / 2) ? 'x' : 'y'; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
895 char *suffix = (i % 2) ? ".negative" : ".positive"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
896 size_t prefix_len = strlen(prefix), suffix_len = strlen(suffix); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
897 size_t full_key_size = axes_key_size + prefix_len + 1 + suffix_len + 2; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
898 char *full_key = malloc(full_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
899 memcpy(full_key, axes_key, axes_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
900 memcpy(full_key + axes_key_size, prefix, prefix_len); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
901 full_key[axes_key_size+prefix_len] = axis; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
902 memcpy(full_key + axes_key_size + prefix_len + 1, suffix, suffix_len +1); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
903 full_key[axes_key_size + prefix_len + 1 + suffix_len + 1] = 0; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
904 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
905 if (bindings[i]) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
906 tern_insert_path(config, full_key, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(bindings[i])}, TVAL_PTR); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
907 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
908 tern_val prev_val; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
909 uint8_t prev_type = tern_delete_path(&config, full_key, &prev_val); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
910 if (prev_type == TVAL_PTR) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
911 free(prev_val.ptrval); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
912 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
913 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
914 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
915 free(full_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
916 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
917 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
918 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
919 static pad_bind_config *bindings; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
920 static void handle_dest_clicked(uint32_t dest) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
921 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
922 char key_buf[12]; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
923 char *key; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
924 switch (dest) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
925 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
926 case SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS: |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
927 key = make_controller_type_key(&selected_controller_info); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
928 break; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
929 case IDENTICAL_CONTROLLERS: |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
930 key = render_joystick_type_id(selected_controller); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
931 break; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
932 case BY_INDEX: |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
933 snprintf(key_buf, sizeof(key_buf), "%d", selected_controller); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
934 key = key_buf; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
935 break; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
936 default: |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
937 key = "default"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
938 break; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
939 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
940 static const char base_path[] = "bindings\0pads"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
941 size_t pad_key_size = sizeof(base_path) + strlen(key) + 1; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
942 char *pad_key = malloc(pad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
943 memcpy(pad_key, base_path, sizeof(base_path)); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
944 strcpy(pad_key + sizeof(base_path), key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
945 static const char dpad_base[] = "dpads\0""0"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
946 size_t dpad_key_size = pad_key_size + sizeof(dpad_base); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
947 char *dpad_key = malloc(dpad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
948 memcpy(dpad_key, pad_key, pad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
949 memcpy(dpad_key + pad_key_size, dpad_base, sizeof(dpad_base)); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
950 static const char button_base[] = "buttons"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
951 size_t button_key_size = pad_key_size + sizeof(button_base); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
952 char *button_key = malloc(button_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
953 memcpy(button_key, pad_key, pad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
954 memcpy(button_key + pad_key_size, button_base, sizeof(button_base)); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
955 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
956 char *final_key; |
2307
a8080240cb92
Fix silly bug I introduced when trying to fix the problem from the SDL2 upgrade
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2306
diff
changeset
|
957 for (int i = 0; i < SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX; i++) |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
958 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
959 char *base; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
960 const char *suffix; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
961 size_t base_key_len; |
2299
a1c9edf44c7e
Fix a place I missed a problem from the SDL2 upgrade
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2294
diff
changeset
|
962 if ( i < SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP || i > SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_RIGHT) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
963 suffix = SDL_GameControllerGetStringForButton(i); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
964 base_key_len = button_key_size; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
965 base = button_key; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
966 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
967 static const char *dir_keys[] = {"up", "down", "left", "right"}; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
968 suffix = dir_keys[i - SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP]; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
969 base = dpad_key; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
970 base_key_len = dpad_key_size; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
971 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
972 size_t suffix_len = strlen(suffix); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
973 final_key = malloc(base_key_len + suffix_len + 2); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
974 memcpy(final_key, base, base_key_len); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
975 memcpy(final_key + base_key_len, suffix, suffix_len + 1); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
976 final_key[base_key_len + suffix_len + 1] = 0; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
977 if (bindings->button_binds[i]) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
978 tern_insert_path(config, final_key, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(bindings->button_binds[i])}, TVAL_PTR); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
979 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
980 tern_val prev_val; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
981 uint8_t prev_type = tern_delete_path(&config, final_key, &prev_val); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
982 if (prev_type == TVAL_PTR) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
983 free(prev_val.ptrval); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
984 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
985 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
986 free(final_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
987 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
988 free(button_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
989 free(dpad_key); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
990 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
991 static const char axes_base[] = "axes"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
992 size_t axes_key_size = pad_key_size + sizeof(axes_base); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
993 char *axes_key = malloc(axes_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
994 memcpy(axes_key, pad_key, pad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
995 memcpy(axes_key + pad_key_size, axes_base, sizeof(axes_base)); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
996 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
997 save_stick_binds(axes_key, axes_key_size,bindings->left_stick, "left"); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
998 save_stick_binds(axes_key, axes_key_size,bindings->right_stick, "right"); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
999 for (int i = SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT; i < SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_MAX; i++) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1000 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1001 const char *suffix = SDL_GameControllerGetStringForAxis(i); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1002 size_t suffix_len = strlen(suffix); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1003 final_key = malloc(axes_key_size + suffix_len + 2); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1004 memcpy(final_key, axes_key, axes_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1005 memcpy(final_key + axes_key_size, suffix, suffix_len + 1); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1006 final_key[axes_key_size + suffix_len + 1] = 0; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1007 if (bindings->triggers[i - SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT]) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1008 tern_insert_path(config, final_key, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(bindings->triggers[i - SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT])}, TVAL_PTR); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1009 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1010 tern_val prev_val; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1011 uint8_t prev_type = tern_delete_path(&config, final_key, &prev_val); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1012 if (prev_type == TVAL_PTR) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1013 free(prev_val.ptrval); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1014 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1015 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1016 free(final_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1017 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1018 free(axes_key); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1019 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1020 free(pad_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1021 if (dest == SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1022 free(key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1023 } |
2312
3f2ecd156453
Fix use after free when re-entering controller binding UI after saving bindings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2311
diff
changeset
|
1024 free(bindings); |
3f2ecd156453
Fix use after free when re-entering controller binding UI after saving bindings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2311
diff
changeset
|
1025 bindings = NULL; |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1026 pop_view(); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1027 config_dirty = 1; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1028 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1029 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1030 void view_select_binding_dest(struct nk_context *context) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1031 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1032 static menu_item options[NUM_DEST_TYPES]; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1033 options[IDENTICAL_CONTROLLERS].title = "Use for identical controllers"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1034 options[DEFAULT].title = "Use as default"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1035 options[BY_INDEX].title = by_index_names[selected_controller]; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1036 options[SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS].title = make_human_readable_type_name(&selected_controller_info); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1037 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1038 if (nk_begin(context, "Select Binding Dest", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1039 menu(context, NUM_DEST_TYPES, options, handle_dest_clicked); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1040 nk_end(context); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1041 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1042 free((char *)options[SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS].title); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1043 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1044 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1045 static ui_image *select_best_image(controller_info *info) |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1046 { |
2020
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1047 if (info->variant != VARIANT_NORMAL || info->type == TYPE_SEGA) { |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1048 if (info->type == TYPE_PSX) { |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1049 return controller_ps4_6b; |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1050 } else { |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1051 return controller_gen_6b; |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1052 } |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1053 } else if (info->type == TYPE_PSX) { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1054 return controller_ps4; |
2003
4c418ee9a9d8
Added Wii U controller image
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1980
diff
changeset
|
1055 } else if (info->type == TYPE_NINTENDO) { |
4c418ee9a9d8
Added Wii U controller image
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1980
diff
changeset
|
1056 return controller_wiiu; |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1057 } else { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1058 return controller_360; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1059 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1060 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1061 |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1062 void view_controller_bindings(struct nk_context *context) |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
1063 { |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1064 if (nk_begin(context, "Controller Bindings", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1065 if (!bindings) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1066 bindings = calloc(1, sizeof(*bindings)); |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1067 tern_node *pad = get_binding_node_for_pad(selected_controller, &selected_controller_info); |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1068 if (pad) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1069 tern_foreach(tern_find_node(pad, "buttons"), button_iter, bindings); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1070 tern_foreach(tern_find_node(pad, "axes"), axis_iter, bindings); |
1624
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1071 tern_node *dpad = tern_find_path(pad, "dpads\0" "0\0", TVAL_NODE).ptrval; |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1072 const char *dir_keys[] = {"up", "down", "right", "left"}; |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1073 const int button_idx[] = {SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_DOWN, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_RIGHT, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_LEFT}; |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1074 for (int i = 0; i < NUM_AXIS_DIRS; i++) |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1075 { |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1076 bindings->button_binds[button_idx[i]] = tern_find_ptr(dpad, dir_keys[i]); |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1077 } |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1078 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1079 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1080 |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1081 float orig_height = def_font->handle.height; |
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1082 def_font->handle.height *= 0.5f; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1083 |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1084 uint32_t avail_height = render_height() - 2 * orig_height; |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1085 float desired_width = render_width() * 0.5f, desired_height = avail_height * 0.5f; |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1086 ui_image *controller_image = select_best_image(&selected_controller_info); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1087 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1088 float controller_ratio = (float)controller_image->width / (float)controller_image->height; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1089 |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1090 const struct nk_user_font *font = context->style.font; |
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1091 int MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Right", strlen("Right")) |
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1092 + def_font->handle.width(font->userdata, font->height, "Internal Screenshot", strlen("Internal Screenshot")); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1093 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1094 if (render_width() - desired_width < 2.5f*MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1095 desired_width = render_width() - 2.5f*MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1096 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1097 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1098 if (desired_width / desired_height > controller_ratio) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1099 desired_width = desired_height * controller_ratio; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1100 } else { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1101 desired_height = desired_width / controller_ratio; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1102 } |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1103 float img_left = render_width() / 2.0f - desired_width / 2.0f; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1104 float img_top = avail_height / 2.0f - desired_height / 2.0f; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1105 float img_right = img_left + desired_width; |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1106 float img_bot = img_top + desired_height; |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1107 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, avail_height, INT_MAX); |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1108 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(img_left, img_top, desired_width, desired_height)); |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1109 nk_image(context, controller_image->ui); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1110 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1111 float bind_box_width = (render_width() - img_right) * 0.8f; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1112 if (bind_box_width < MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1113 bind_box_width = render_width() - img_right; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1114 if (bind_box_width > MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1115 bind_box_width = MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1116 } |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1117 } else if (bind_box_width > MAX_BIND_BOX_WIDTH) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1118 bind_box_width = MAX_BIND_BOX_WIDTH; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1119 } |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1120 float bind_box_left; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1121 if (bind_box_width >= (render_width() - img_right)) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1122 bind_box_left = img_right; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1123 } else { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1124 bind_box_left = img_right + (render_width() - img_right) / 2.0f - bind_box_width / 2.0f; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1125 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1126 |
1647
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1127 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1128 binding_box(context, bindings, "Action Buttons", bind_box_left, img_top, bind_box_width, 4, (int[]){ |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1129 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1130 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1131 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_X, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1132 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_Y |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1133 }); |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1134 } else { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1135 binding_box(context, bindings, "Action Buttons", bind_box_left, img_top, bind_box_width, 6, (int[]){ |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1136 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1137 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1138 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT : SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1139 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_X, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1140 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_Y, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1141 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER : SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1142 }); |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1143 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1144 |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1145 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) { |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1146 binding_box(context, bindings, "Right Shoulder", bind_box_left, font->height/2, bind_box_width, 2, (int[]){ |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1147 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER, |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1148 AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1149 }); |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1150 } else { |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1151 binding_box(context, bindings, "Right Shoulder", bind_box_left, font->height/2, bind_box_width, |
2219
ff700f50541c
Fix duplicated right trigger mapping button in bindings for 8-button Genesis style controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2202
diff
changeset
|
1152 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? 2 : 1, |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1153 (int[]){ |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1154 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER : AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT, |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1155 AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1156 }); |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1157 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1158 |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1159 binding_box(context, bindings, "Misc Buttons", (render_width() - bind_box_width) / 2, font->height/2, bind_box_width, 3, (int[]){ |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1160 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_BACK, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1161 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_GUIDE, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1162 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_START |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1163 }); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1164 |
1647
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1165 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1166 { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1167 binding_box(context, bindings, "Right Stick", img_right - desired_width/3, img_bot, bind_box_width, 5, (int[]){ |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1168 RIGHTSTICK | UP, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1169 RIGHTSTICK | DOWN, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1170 RIGHTSTICK | LEFT, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1171 RIGHTSTICK | RIGHT, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1172 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSTICK |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1173 }); |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1174 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1175 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1176 bind_box_left -= img_right; |
1647
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1177 float dpad_left, dpad_top; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1178 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1179 { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1180 binding_box(context, bindings, "Left Stick", bind_box_left, img_top, bind_box_width, 5, (int[]){ |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1181 LEFTSTICK | UP, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1182 LEFTSTICK | DOWN, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1183 LEFTSTICK | LEFT, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1184 LEFTSTICK | RIGHT, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1185 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSTICK |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1186 }); |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1187 dpad_left = img_left - desired_width/6; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1188 dpad_top = img_bot + font->height * 1.5; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1189 } else { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1190 dpad_left = bind_box_left; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1191 dpad_top = img_top; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1192 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1193 |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1194 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) { |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1195 binding_box(context, bindings, "Left Shoulder", bind_box_left, font->height/2, bind_box_width, 2, (int[]){ |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1196 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER, |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1197 AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1198 }); |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1199 } else { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1200 binding_box(context, bindings, "Left Shoulder", bind_box_left, font->height/2, bind_box_width, |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1201 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_BUMPERS ? 1 : 2, |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1202 (int[]){ |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1203 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSTICK : AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT, |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1204 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSTICK |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1205 }); |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1206 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1207 |
1647
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1208 binding_box(context, bindings, "D-pad", dpad_left, dpad_top, bind_box_width, 4, (int[]){ |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1209 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1210 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_DOWN, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1211 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_LEFT, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1212 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_RIGHT |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1213 }); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1214 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1215 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1216 |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1217 def_font->handle.height = orig_height; |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1218 nk_layout_row_static(context, orig_height + 4, (render_width() - 2*orig_height) / 4, 1); |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1219 if (nk_button_label(context, controller_binding_changed ? "Save" : "Back")) { |
1545
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
1220 pop_view(); |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1221 if (controller_binding_changed) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1222 push_view(view_select_binding_dest); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1223 } |
1545
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
1224 } |
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
1225 nk_end(context); |
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
1226 } |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
1227 } |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1228 |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1229 static int current_button; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1230 static int current_axis; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1231 static int button_pressed, last_button; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1232 static int hat_moved, hat_value, last_hat, last_hat_value; |
1804
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1233 static int axis_moved, axis_value, last_axis, last_axis_value; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1234 static char *mapping_string; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1235 static size_t mapping_pos; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1236 |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1237 static void start_mapping(void) |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1238 { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1239 const char *name; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1240 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = ','; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1241 if (current_button != SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1242 name = SDL_GameControllerGetStringForButton(current_button); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1243 } else { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1244 name = SDL_GameControllerGetStringForAxis(current_axis); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1245 } |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1246 size_t namesz = strlen(name); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1247 memcpy(mapping_string + mapping_pos, name, namesz); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1248 mapping_pos += namesz; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1249 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = ':'; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1250 } |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1251 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1252 static uint8_t initial_controller_config; |
1605
f7b1d983d5c0
Bump up pause between mapping inputs
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1604
diff
changeset
|
1253 #define QUIET_FRAMES 9 |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1254 static void view_controller_mappings(struct nk_context *context) |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1255 { |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1256 char buffer[512]; |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1257 static int quiet, button_a = -1, button_a_axis = -1; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1258 uint8_t added_mapping = 0; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1259 if (nk_begin(context, "Controllers", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1260 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1261 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, render_height() - context->style.font->height, 3); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1262 |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1263 if (current_button < SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1264 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "Press Button %s", get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, current_button)); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1265 } else { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1266 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "Move Axis %s", get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, current_axis)); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1267 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1268 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1269 float height = context->style.font->height * 1.25; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1270 float top = render_height()/2 - 1.5 * height; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1271 float width = render_width() - context->style.font->height; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1272 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1273 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(0, top, width, height)); |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1274 nk_label(context, buffer, NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1275 if (current_button > SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1276 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(0, top + height, width, height)); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1277 nk_label(context, "OR", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1278 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1279 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(0, top + 2.0 * height, width, height)); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1280 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "Press Button %s to skip", get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A)); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1281 nk_label(context, buffer, NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1282 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1283 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1284 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1285 if (quiet) { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1286 --quiet; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1287 } else { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1288 if (button_pressed >= 0 && button_pressed != last_button) { |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1289 if (current_button <= SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B || button_pressed != button_a) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1290 start_mapping(); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1291 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = 'b'; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1292 if (button_pressed > 9) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1293 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + button_pressed / 10; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1294 } |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1295 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + button_pressed % 10; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1296 last_button = button_pressed; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1297 if (current_button == SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1298 button_a = button_pressed; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1299 } |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1300 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1301 added_mapping = 1; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1302 } else if (hat_moved >= 0 && hat_value && (hat_moved != last_hat || hat_value != last_hat_value)) { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1303 start_mapping(); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1304 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = 'h'; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1305 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + hat_moved; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1306 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '.'; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1307 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + hat_value; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1308 added_mapping = 1; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1309 |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1310 last_hat = hat_moved; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1311 last_hat_value = hat_value; |
2319
ab3d8759da08
Slightly more reasonable threshold value for axes during mapping. Still pretty broken though
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
1312 } else if (axis_moved >= 0 && abs(axis_value) > 4000 && ( |
1804
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1313 axis_moved != last_axis || ( |
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1314 axis_value/abs(axis_value) != last_axis_value/abs(axis_value) && current_button >= SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP |
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1315 ) |
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1316 )) { |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1317 if (current_button <= SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B || axis_moved != button_a_axis) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1318 start_mapping(); |
2022
380bc5d4a2cf
Fix format of axis mapping strings for axes that map to a d-pad
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2020
diff
changeset
|
1319 if (current_button >= SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP) { |
380bc5d4a2cf
Fix format of axis mapping strings for axes that map to a d-pad
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2020
diff
changeset
|
1320 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = axis_value >= 0 ? '+' : '-'; |
380bc5d4a2cf
Fix format of axis mapping strings for axes that map to a d-pad
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2020
diff
changeset
|
1321 } |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1322 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = 'a'; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1323 if (axis_moved > 9) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1324 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + axis_moved / 10; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1325 } |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1326 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + axis_moved % 10; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1327 last_axis = axis_moved; |
1804
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1328 last_axis_value = axis_value; |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1329 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1330 added_mapping = 1; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1331 } |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1332 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1333 |
1806
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1334 while (added_mapping) { |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1335 quiet = QUIET_FRAMES; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1336 if (current_button < SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1337 current_button++; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1338 if (current_button == SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1339 current_axis = 0; |
1806
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1340 if (get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, current_axis)) { |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1341 added_mapping = 0; |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1342 } |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1343 } else if (get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, current_button)) { |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1344 added_mapping = 0; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1345 } |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1346 } else { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1347 current_axis++; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1348 if (current_axis == SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_MAX) { |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1349 button_a = -1; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1350 button_a_axis = -1; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1351 mapping_string[mapping_pos] = 0; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1352 save_controller_mapping(selected_controller, mapping_string); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1353 free(mapping_string); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1354 pop_view(); |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1355 if (initial_controller_config) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1356 push_view(view_controller_bindings); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1357 controller_binding_changed = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1358 } |
1806
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1359 added_mapping = 0; |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1360 } else if (get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, current_axis)) { |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1361 added_mapping = 0; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1362 } |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1363 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1364 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1365 button_pressed = -1; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1366 hat_moved = -1; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1367 axis_moved = -1; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1368 nk_end(context); |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1369 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1370 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1371 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1372 static void show_mapping_view(void) |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1373 { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1374 current_button = SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1375 button_pressed = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1376 last_button = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1377 last_hat = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1378 axis_moved = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1379 last_axis = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1380 last_axis_value = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1381 SDL_Joystick *joy = render_get_joystick(selected_controller); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1382 const char *name = SDL_JoystickName(joy); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1383 size_t namesz = strlen(name); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1384 mapping_string = malloc(512 + namesz); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1385 for (mapping_pos = 0; mapping_pos < namesz; mapping_pos++) |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1386 { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1387 char c = name[mapping_pos]; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1388 if (c == ',' || c == '\n' || c == '\r') { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1389 c = ' '; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1390 } |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1391 mapping_string[mapping_pos] = c; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1392 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1393 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1394 push_view(view_controller_mappings); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1395 } |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1396 |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1397 static void view_controller_variant(struct nk_context *context) |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1398 { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1399 uint8_t selected = 0; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1400 if (nk_begin(context, "Controller Type", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1401 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height*1.25, render_width() - context->style.font->height * 2, 1); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1402 nk_label(context, "", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1403 nk_label(context, "Select the layout that", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1404 nk_label(context, "best matches your controller", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1405 nk_label(context, "", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
2015
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1406 if (selected_controller_info.subtype == SUBTYPE_GENESIS) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1407 if (nk_button_label(context, "3 button")) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1408 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_3BUTTON; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1409 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1410 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1411 if (nk_button_label(context, "Standard 6 button")) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1412 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_6B_BUMPERS; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1413 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1414 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1415 if (nk_button_label(context, "6 button with 2 shoulder buttons")) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1416 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_8BUTTON; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1417 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1418 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1419 } else { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1420 if (nk_button_label(context, "4 face buttons")) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1421 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_NORMAL; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1422 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1423 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1424 char buffer[512]; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1425 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "6 face buttons including %s and %s", |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1426 get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER), |
2015
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1427 get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT) |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1428 ); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1429 if (nk_button_label(context, buffer)) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1430 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_6B_RIGHT; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1431 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1432 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1433 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "6 face buttons including %s and %s", |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1434 get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER), |
2015
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1435 get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER) |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1436 ); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1437 if (nk_button_label(context, buffer)) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1438 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_6B_BUMPERS; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1439 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1440 } |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1441 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1442 nk_end(context); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1443 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1444 if (selected) { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1445 save_controller_info(selected_controller, &selected_controller_info); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1446 pop_view(); |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1447 if (initial_controller_config) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1448 SDL_GameController *controller = render_get_controller(selected_controller); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1449 if (controller) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1450 push_view(view_controller_bindings); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1451 controller_binding_changed = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1452 SDL_GameControllerClose(controller); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1453 } else { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1454 show_mapping_view(); |
1604
68b05322d971
Don't redundantly store controller GUID when saving a mapping. Remove illegal chars from controller name
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1602
diff
changeset
|
1455 } |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1456 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1457 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1458 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1459 |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1460 static void controller_type_group(struct nk_context *context, char *name, int type_id, int first_subtype_id, const char **types, uint32_t num_types) |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1461 { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1462 nk_layout_row_static(context, (context->style.font->height + 3) * num_types + context->style.font->height, render_width() - 80, 1); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1463 if (nk_group_begin(context, name, NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1464 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, render_width()/2 - 80, 2); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1465 for (int i = 0; i < num_types; i++) |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1466 { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1467 if (nk_button_label(context, types[i])) { |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1468 selected_controller_info.type = type_id; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1469 selected_controller_info.subtype = first_subtype_id + i; |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1470 pop_view(); |
2015
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1471 if (selected_controller_info.subtype == SUBTYPE_SATURN) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1472 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_6B_BUMPERS; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1473 save_controller_info(selected_controller, &selected_controller_info); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1474 if (initial_controller_config) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1475 SDL_GameController *controller = render_get_controller(selected_controller); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1476 if (controller) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1477 push_view(view_controller_bindings); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1478 controller_binding_changed = 0; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1479 SDL_GameControllerClose(controller); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1480 } else { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1481 show_mapping_view(); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1482 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1483 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1484 } else { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1485 push_view(view_controller_variant); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1486 } |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1487 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1488 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1489 nk_group_end(context); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1490 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1491 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1492 |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1493 void view_controller_type(struct nk_context *context) |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1494 { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1495 if (nk_begin(context, "Controller Type", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1496 controller_type_group(context, "Xbox", TYPE_XBOX, SUBTYPE_XBOX, (const char *[]){ |
2220
dd9d43c67986
Add support for newer controller types. Fix crash caused by new controller button types introduced in 2.0.12 and support mapping them
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2219
diff
changeset
|
1497 "Original", "Xbox 360", "Xbox One/Series", "Xbox Elite" |
dd9d43c67986
Add support for newer controller types. Fix crash caused by new controller button types introduced in 2.0.12 and support mapping them
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2219
diff
changeset
|
1498 }, 4); |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1499 controller_type_group(context, "Playstation", TYPE_PSX, SUBTYPE_PS3, (const char *[]){ |
2220
dd9d43c67986
Add support for newer controller types. Fix crash caused by new controller button types introduced in 2.0.12 and support mapping them
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2219
diff
changeset
|
1500 "PS3", "PS4", "PS5" |
dd9d43c67986
Add support for newer controller types. Fix crash caused by new controller button types introduced in 2.0.12 and support mapping them
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2219
diff
changeset
|
1501 }, 3); |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1502 controller_type_group(context, "Sega", TYPE_SEGA, SUBTYPE_GENESIS, (const char *[]){ |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1503 "Genesis", "Saturn" |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1504 }, 2); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1505 controller_type_group(context, "Nintendo", TYPE_NINTENDO, SUBTYPE_WIIU, (const char *[]){ |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1506 "WiiU", "Switch" |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1507 }, 2); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1508 nk_end(context); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1509 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1510 } |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1511 static uint8_t stick_nav_disabled; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1512 static SDL_GameController *current_controller; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1513 static uint8_t deadzones_dirty; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1514 void stick_deadzone_widget(float left, float top, float size, SDL_GameControllerAxis x_axis) |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1515 { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1516 float crosshair_size = context->style.font->height; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1517 nk_stroke_rect(&context->current->buffer, nk_rect(left, top, size, size), context->style.window.rounding, context->style.window.border, nk_rgb(255, 255, 255)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1518 float deadzone_size = selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone * size / 65535.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1519 int16_t raw_x = SDL_GameControllerGetAxis(current_controller, x_axis); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1520 int16_t raw_y = SDL_GameControllerGetAxis(current_controller, x_axis + 1); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1521 if (raw_x > selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1522 float points[] = { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1523 left + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1524 left + size, top, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1525 left + size, top + size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1526 left + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1527 }; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1528 nk_fill_polygon(&context->current->buffer, points, sizeof(points)/(2 * sizeof(float)), context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1529 } else if (raw_x < -selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1530 float points[] = { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1531 left, top, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1532 left + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1533 left + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1534 left, top + size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1535 }; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1536 nk_fill_polygon(&context->current->buffer, points, sizeof(points)/(2 * sizeof(float)), context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1537 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1538 if (raw_y > selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1539 float points[] = { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1540 left, top + size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1541 left + size, top + size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1542 left + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1543 left + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1544 }; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1545 nk_fill_polygon(&context->current->buffer, points, sizeof(points)/(2 * sizeof(float)), context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1546 } else if (raw_y < -selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1547 float points[] = { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1548 left, top, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1549 left + size, top, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1550 left + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1551 left + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1552 }; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1553 nk_fill_polygon(&context->current->buffer, points, sizeof(points)/(2 * sizeof(float)), context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1554 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1555 nk_stroke_rect(&context->current->buffer, nk_rect(left + 0.5f * size - deadzone_size, top + 0.5f * size - deadzone_size, 2 * deadzone_size, 2 * deadzone_size), context->style.window.rounding, 0.5f * context->style.window.border, nk_rgb(200, 200, 200)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1556 //nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(left, top, size, size)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1557 float x = raw_x * size / 65535.0f + size / 2.0f - crosshair_size / 2.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1558 float y = raw_y * size / 65535.0f + size / 2.0f - crosshair_size / 2.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1559 nk_draw_symbol(&context->current->buffer, NK_SYMBOL_X, nk_rect(left + x, top + y, crosshair_size, crosshair_size), nk_rgb(0, 0, 0), nk_rgb(255, 255, 255), 1, context->style.font); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1560 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1561 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1562 void trigger_deadzone_widget(float left, float top, float size, SDL_GameControllerAxis axis) |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1563 { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1564 float crosshair_size = context->style.font->height; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1565 nk_stroke_rect(&context->current->buffer, nk_rect(left, top, size, crosshair_size * 1.5f), context->style.window.rounding, context->style.window.border, nk_rgb(255, 255, 255)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1566 float deadzone_size = selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone * size / 32767.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1567 int16_t raw = SDL_GameControllerGetAxis(current_controller, axis); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1568 if (raw < 0) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1569 raw = 0; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1570 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1571 if (raw > selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1572 nk_fill_rect(&context->current->buffer, nk_rect(left + deadzone_size, top, size - deadzone_size, 1.5f * crosshair_size), context->style.window.rounding, context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1573 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1574 nk_stroke_line(&context->current->buffer, left + deadzone_size, top, left + deadzone_size, top + 1.5f * crosshair_size, 0.5f * context->style.window.border, nk_rgb(200, 200, 200)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1575 float x = raw * size / 32767.0f - crosshair_size / 2.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1576 nk_draw_symbol(&context->current->buffer, NK_SYMBOL_X, nk_rect(left + x, top + 0.25f * crosshair_size, crosshair_size, crosshair_size), nk_rgb(0, 0, 0), nk_rgb(255, 255, 255), 1, context->style.font); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1577 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1578 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1579 void view_deadzones(struct nk_context *context) |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1580 { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1581 if (nk_begin(context, "Deadzones", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1582 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, render_height() - 3 * context->style.font->height, 4); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1583 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1584 float left = render_width() / 8.0f, top = render_height() / 8.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1585 float size = render_height() / 3.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1586 stick_deadzone_widget(left, top, size, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTX); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1587 stick_deadzone_widget(left + 1.25f * size, top, size, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_RIGHTX); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1588 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1589 top += size + context->style.font->height; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1590 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(left, top, size * 2, context->style.font->height)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1591 int val = selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1592 nk_property_int(context, "Stick Deadzone", 250, &val, 32000, 250, 1.0f); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1593 if (val != selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1594 selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone = val; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1595 deadzones_dirty = 1; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1596 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1597 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1598 top += 2.0f * context->style.font->height; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1599 trigger_deadzone_widget(left, top, size, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1600 trigger_deadzone_widget(left + 1.25f * size, top, size, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1601 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1602 top += context->style.font->height * 2.5f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1603 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(left, top, size * 2, context->style.font->height)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1604 val = selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1605 nk_property_int(context, "Trigger Deadzone", 250, &val, 32000, 250, 1.0f); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1606 if (val != selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1607 selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone = val; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1608 deadzones_dirty = 1; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1609 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1610 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1611 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1612 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1613 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, (render_width() - 2 * context->style.font->height) / 2, 2); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1614 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1615 stick_nav_disabled = 0; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1616 if (current_controller) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1617 SDL_GameControllerClose(current_controller); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1618 current_controller = NULL; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1619 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1620 if (deadzones_dirty) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1621 save_controller_info(selected_controller, &selected_controller_info); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1622 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1623 pop_view(); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1624 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1625 nk_end(context); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1626 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1627 } |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1628 |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1629 void view_controllers(struct nk_context *context) |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1630 { |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1631 if (nk_begin(context, "Controllers", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1632 int height = (render_height() - 2*context->style.font->height) / 5; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1633 int inner_height = height - context->style.window.spacing.y; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1634 const struct nk_user_font *font = context->style.font; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1635 int bindings_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Bindings", strlen("Bindings")) + context->style.button.padding.x * 2; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1636 int remap_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Remap", strlen("Remap")) + context->style.button.padding.x * 2; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1637 int change_type_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Change Type", strlen("Change Type")) + context->style.button.padding.x * 2; |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1638 int deadzones_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Deadzones", strlen("Deadzones")) + context->style.button.padding.x * 2; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1639 int total = bindings_width + remap_width + change_type_width + deadzones_width; |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1640 float bindings_ratio = (float)bindings_width / total; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1641 float remap_ratio = (float)remap_width / total; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1642 float change_type_ratio = (float)change_type_width / total; |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1643 float deadzones_ratio = (float)deadzones_width / total; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1644 |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1645 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1646 uint8_t found_controller = 0; |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1647 for (int i = 0; i < MAX_JOYSTICKS; i++) |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1648 { |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1649 SDL_Joystick *joy = render_get_joystick(i); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1650 if (joy) { |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1651 found_controller = 1; |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1652 controller_info info = get_controller_info(i); |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1653 ui_image *controller_image = select_best_image(&info); |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1654 int image_width = inner_height * controller_image->width / controller_image->height; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1655 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, height, INT_MAX); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1656 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(context->style.font->height / 2, 0, image_width, inner_height)); |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1657 if (info.type == TYPE_UNKNOWN || info.type == TYPE_GENERIC_MAPPING) { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1658 nk_label(context, "?", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1659 } else { |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1660 nk_image(context, controller_image->ui); |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1661 } |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1662 int button_start = image_width + context->style.font->height; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1663 int button_area_width = render_width() - image_width - 2 * context->style.font->height; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1664 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1665 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, 0, button_area_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1666 nk_label(context, info.name, NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1667 const struct nk_user_font *font = context->style.font; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1668 if (info.type == TYPE_UNKNOWN || info.type == TYPE_GENERIC_MAPPING) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1669 int button_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Configure", strlen("Configure")); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1670 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, button_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1671 if (nk_button_label(context, "Configure")) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1672 selected_controller = i; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1673 selected_controller_info = info; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1674 initial_controller_config = 1; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1675 push_view(view_controller_type); |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1676 } |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1677 } else { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1678 button_area_width -= 2 * context->style.window.spacing.x; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1679 bindings_width = bindings_ratio * button_area_width; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1680 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, bindings_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1681 if (nk_button_label(context, "Bindings")) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1682 selected_controller = i; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1683 selected_controller_info = info; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1684 push_view(view_controller_bindings); |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1685 controller_binding_changed = 0; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1686 } |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1687 button_start += bindings_width + context->style.window.spacing.x; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1688 remap_width = remap_ratio * button_area_width; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1689 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, remap_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1690 if (nk_button_label(context, "Remap")) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1691 selected_controller = i; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1692 selected_controller_info = info; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1693 initial_controller_config = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1694 show_mapping_view(); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1695 } |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1696 button_start += remap_width + context->style.window.spacing.x; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1697 change_type_width = change_type_ratio * button_area_width; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1698 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, change_type_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1699 if (nk_button_label(context, "Change Type")) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1700 selected_controller = i; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1701 selected_controller_info = info; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1702 initial_controller_config = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1703 push_view(view_controller_type); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1704 } |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1705 button_start += change_type_width + context->style.window.spacing.x; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1706 deadzones_width = deadzones_ratio * button_area_width; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1707 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, deadzones_width, inner_height/2)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1708 if (nk_button_label(context, "Deadzones")) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1709 selected_controller = i; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1710 selected_controller_info = info; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1711 current_controller = render_get_controller(i); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1712 stick_nav_disabled = 1; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1713 deadzones_dirty = 0; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1714 push_view(view_deadzones); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1715 } |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1716 } |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1717 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1718 } |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1719 } |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1720 if (!found_controller) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1721 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, render_width() - 2 * context->style.font->height, 1); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1722 nk_label(context, "No controllers detected", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1723 } |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1724 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, (render_width() - 2 * context->style.font->height) / 2, 2); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1725 nk_label(context, "", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1726 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1727 pop_view(); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1728 } |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1729 nk_end(context); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1730 } |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1731 } |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1732 |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1733 void settings_toggle(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *path, uint8_t def) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1734 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1735 uint8_t curval = !strcmp("on", tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def ? "on": "off"}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1736 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1737 uint8_t newval = nk_check_label(context, "", curval); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1738 if (newval != curval) { |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
1739 config_dirty = 1; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1740 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(newval ? "on" : "off")}, TVAL_PTR); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1741 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1742 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1743 |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1744 void settings_int_input(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *path, char *def) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1745 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1746 char buffer[12]; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1747 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1748 uint32_t curval; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1749 char *curstr = tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1750 uint32_t len = strlen(curstr); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1751 if (len > 11) { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1752 len = 11; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1753 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1754 memcpy(buffer, curstr, len); |
1593
24508cb54f87
Fix a number of other memory errors (mostly leaks again) identified by valgrind
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1581
diff
changeset
|
1755 memset(buffer+len, 0, sizeof(buffer)-len); |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1756 nk_edit_string(context, NK_EDIT_SIMPLE, buffer, &len, sizeof(buffer)-1, nk_filter_decimal); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1757 buffer[len] = 0; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1758 if (strcmp(buffer, curstr)) { |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
1759 config_dirty = 1; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1760 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1761 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1762 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1763 |
1853
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1764 void settings_string(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *path, char *def) |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1765 { |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1766 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1767 char *curstr = tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1768 uint32_t len = strlen(curstr); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1769 uint32_t buffer_len = len > 100 ? len + 1 : 101; |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1770 char *buffer = malloc(buffer_len); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1771 memcpy(buffer, curstr, len); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1772 memset(buffer+len, 0, buffer_len-len); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1773 nk_edit_string(context, NK_EDIT_SIMPLE, buffer, &len, buffer_len-1, nk_filter_default); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1774 buffer[len] = 0; |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1775 if (strcmp(buffer, curstr)) { |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1776 config_dirty = 1; |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1777 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1778 } |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1779 free(buffer); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1780 } |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1781 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1782 void settings_path(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *path, char *def, const char **exts, uint32_t num_exts) |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1783 { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1784 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1785 char *curstr = tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1786 uint32_t len = strlen(curstr); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1787 uint32_t buffer_len = len > 100 ? len + 1 : 101; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1788 char *buffer = malloc(buffer_len); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1789 memcpy(buffer, curstr, len); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1790 memset(buffer+len, 0, buffer_len-len); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1791 nk_edit_string(context, NK_EDIT_SIMPLE, buffer, &len, buffer_len-1, nk_filter_default); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1792 buffer[len] = 0; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1793 if (strcmp(buffer, curstr)) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1794 config_dirty = 1; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1795 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1796 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1797 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1798 nk_spacing(context, 1); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1799 if (nk_button_label(context, "Browse")) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1800 browser_label = label; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1801 browser_setting_path = path; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1802 browser_ext_list = exts; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1803 browser_num_exts = num_exts; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1804 if (is_absolute_path(buffer)) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1805 browser_cur_path = path_dirname(buffer); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1806 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1807 push_view(view_file_settings); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1808 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1809 free(buffer); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1810 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1811 |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1812 void settings_int_property(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *name, char *path, int def, int min, int max) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1813 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1814 char *curstr = tern_find_path(config, path, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1815 int curval = curstr ? atoi(curstr) : def; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1816 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1817 int val = curval; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1818 nk_property_int(context, name, min, &val, max, 1, 1.0f); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1819 if (val != curval) { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1820 char buffer[12]; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1821 sprintf(buffer, "%d", val); |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
1822 config_dirty = 1; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1823 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1824 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1825 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1826 |
1796
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1827 void settings_float_property(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *name, char *path, float def, float min, float max, float step) |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1828 { |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1829 char *curstr = tern_find_path(config, path, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1830 float curval = curstr ? atof(curstr) : def; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1831 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1832 float val = curval; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1833 nk_property_float(context, name, min, &val, max, step, step); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1834 if (val != curval) { |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1835 char buffer[64]; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1836 sprintf(buffer, "%f", val); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1837 config_dirty = 1; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1838 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1839 } |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1840 } |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1841 |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1842 typedef struct { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1843 char *fragment; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1844 char *vertex; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1845 } shader_prog; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1846 |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1847 shader_prog *get_shader_progs(dir_entry *entries, size_t num_entries, shader_prog *progs, uint32_t *num_existing, uint32_t *storage) |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1848 { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1849 uint32_t num_progs = *num_existing; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1850 uint32_t prog_storage = *storage; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1851 uint32_t starting = num_progs; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1852 |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1853 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_entries; i++) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1854 if (entries[i].is_dir) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1855 continue; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1856 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1857 char *no_ext = basename_no_extension(entries[i].name); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1858 uint32_t len = strlen(no_ext); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1859 if (no_ext[len-1] == 'f' && no_ext[len-2] == '.') { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1860 uint8_t dupe = 0;; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1861 for (uint32_t j = 0; j < starting; j++) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1862 if (!strcmp(entries[i].name, progs[j].fragment)) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1863 dupe = 1; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1864 break; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1865 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1866 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1867 if (!dupe) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1868 if (num_progs == prog_storage) { |
1493
24f44f26b74d
Fix buffer overrun in video settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1492
diff
changeset
|
1869 prog_storage = prog_storage ? prog_storage*2 : 4; |
1857
1844cf5a4045
Fix buffer overrun in shader list UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1855
diff
changeset
|
1870 progs = realloc(progs, sizeof(*progs) * prog_storage); |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1871 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1872 progs[num_progs].vertex = NULL; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1873 progs[num_progs++].fragment = strdup(entries[i].name); |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1874 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1875 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1876 free(no_ext); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1877 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1878 |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1879 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_entries; i++) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1880 if (entries[i].is_dir) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1881 continue; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1882 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1883 char *no_ext = basename_no_extension(entries[i].name); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1884 uint32_t len = strlen(no_ext); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1885 if (no_ext[len-1] == 'v' && no_ext[len-2] == '.') { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1886 for (uint32_t j = 0; j < num_progs; j++) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1887 if (!strncmp(no_ext, progs[j].fragment, len-1) && progs[j].fragment[len-1] == 'f' && progs[j].fragment[len] == '.') { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1888 progs[j].vertex = strdup(entries[i].name); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1889 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1890 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1891 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1892 free(no_ext); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1893 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1894 free_dir_list(entries, num_entries); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1895 *num_existing = num_progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1896 *storage = prog_storage; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1897 return progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1898 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1899 |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1900 shader_prog *get_shader_list(uint32_t *num_out) |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1901 { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1902 char *shader_dir = path_append(get_config_dir(), "shaders"); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1903 size_t num_entries; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1904 dir_entry *entries = get_dir_list(shader_dir, &num_entries); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1905 free(shader_dir); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1906 shader_prog *progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1907 uint32_t num_progs = 0, prog_storage; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1908 if (num_entries) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1909 progs = calloc(num_entries, sizeof(shader_prog)); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1910 prog_storage = num_entries; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1911 progs = get_shader_progs(entries, num_entries, progs, &num_progs, &prog_storage); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1912 } else { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1913 progs = NULL; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1914 prog_storage = 0; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1915 } |
1693
ba3fb7a3be6b
Added some Makefile options to build a packaging friendly executable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1681
diff
changeset
|
1916 #ifdef DATA_PATH |
ba3fb7a3be6b
Added some Makefile options to build a packaging friendly executable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1681
diff
changeset
|
1917 shader_dir = path_append(DATA_PATH, "shaders"); |
ba3fb7a3be6b
Added some Makefile options to build a packaging friendly executable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1681
diff
changeset
|
1918 #else |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1919 shader_dir = path_append(get_exe_dir(), "shaders"); |
1693
ba3fb7a3be6b
Added some Makefile options to build a packaging friendly executable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1681
diff
changeset
|
1920 #endif |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1921 entries = get_dir_list(shader_dir, &num_entries); |
1858
dda7479f3bbb
Fix a couple of small memory leaks
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1857
diff
changeset
|
1922 free(shader_dir); |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1923 progs = get_shader_progs(entries, num_entries, progs, &num_progs, &prog_storage); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1924 *num_out = num_progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1925 return progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1926 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1927 |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1928 int32_t find_match(const char **options, uint32_t num_options, char *path, char *def) |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1929 { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1930 char *setting = tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1931 int32_t selected = -1; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1932 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_options; i++) |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1933 { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1934 if (!strcmp(setting, options[i])) { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1935 selected = i; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1936 break; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1937 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1938 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1939 if (selected == -1) { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1940 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_options; i++) |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1941 { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1942 if (!strcmp(def, options[i])) { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1943 selected = i; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1944 break; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1945 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1946 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1947 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1948 return selected; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1949 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1950 |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1951 int32_t settings_dropdown_ex(struct nk_context *context, char *label, const char **options, const char **opt_display, uint32_t num_options, int32_t current, char *path) |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1952 { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1953 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1954 int32_t next = nk_combo(context, opt_display, num_options, current, 30, nk_vec2(300, 300)); |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1955 if (next != current) { |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
1956 config_dirty = 1; |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1957 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(options[next])}, TVAL_PTR); |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1958 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1959 return next; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1960 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1961 |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1962 int32_t settings_dropdown(struct nk_context *context, char *label, const char **options, uint32_t num_options, int32_t current, char *path) |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1963 { |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1964 return settings_dropdown_ex(context, label, options, options, num_options, current, path); |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1965 } |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1966 |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1967 void view_video_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1968 { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1969 const char *vsync_opts[] = {"on", "off", "tear"}; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1970 const char *vsync_opt_names[] = { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1971 "On", |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1972 "Off", |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1973 "On, tear if late" |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1974 }; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1975 const uint32_t num_vsync_opts = sizeof(vsync_opts)/sizeof(*vsync_opts); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1976 static shader_prog *progs; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1977 static char **prog_names; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1978 static uint32_t num_progs; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1979 static uint32_t selected_prog; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1980 static int32_t selected_vsync = -1; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1981 if (selected_vsync < 0) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1982 selected_vsync = find_match(vsync_opts, num_vsync_opts, "video\0vsync\0", "off"); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1983 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1984 if(!progs) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1985 progs = get_shader_list(&num_progs); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1986 prog_names = calloc(num_progs, sizeof(char*)); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1987 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_progs; i++) |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1988 { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1989 prog_names[i] = basename_no_extension(progs[i].fragment);; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1990 uint32_t len = strlen(prog_names[i]); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1991 if (len > 2) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1992 prog_names[i][len-2] = 0; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1993 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1994 if (!progs[i].vertex) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1995 progs[i].vertex = strdup("default.v.glsl"); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1996 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1997 if (!strcmp( |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1998 progs[i].fragment, |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1999 tern_find_path_default(config, "video\0fragment_shader\0", (tern_val){.ptrval = "default.f.glsl"}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2000 )) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2001 selected_prog = i; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2002 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2003 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2004 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2005 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2006 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2007 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2008 if (desired_width > width) { |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2009 desired_width = width; |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2010 } |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2011 if (nk_begin(context, "Video Settings", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2012 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, desired_width, 2); |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2013 settings_toggle(context, "Fullscreen", "video\0fullscreen\0", 0); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2014 settings_toggle(context, "Open GL", "video\0gl\0", 1); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2015 settings_toggle(context, "Scanlines", "video\0scanlines\0", 0); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2016 selected_vsync = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "VSync", vsync_opts, vsync_opt_names, num_vsync_opts, selected_vsync, "video\0vsync\0"); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2017 settings_int_input(context, "Windowed Width", "video\0width\0", "640"); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2018 nk_label(context, "Shader", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2019 uint32_t next_selected = nk_combo(context, (const char **)prog_names, num_progs, selected_prog, context->style.font->height, nk_vec2(desired_width, desired_width)); |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2020 if (next_selected != selected_prog) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2021 selected_prog = next_selected; |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2022 config_dirty = 1; |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2023 config = tern_insert_path(config, "video\0fragment_shader\0", (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(progs[next_selected].fragment)}, TVAL_PTR); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2024 config = tern_insert_path(config, "video\0vertex_shader\0", (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(progs[next_selected].vertex)}, TVAL_PTR); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2025 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2026 settings_int_property(context, "NTSC Overscan", "Top", "video\0ntsc\0overscan\0top\0", 2, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2027 settings_int_property(context, "", "Bottom", "video\0ntsc\0overscan\0bottom\0", 17, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2028 settings_int_property(context, "", "Left", "video\0ntsc\0overscan\0left\0", 13, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2029 settings_int_property(context, "", "Right", "video\0ntsc\0overscan\0right\0", 14, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2030 settings_int_property(context, "PAL Overscan", "Top", "video\0pal\0overscan\0top\0", 2, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2031 settings_int_property(context, "", "Bottom", "video\0pal\0overscan\0bottom\0", 17, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2032 settings_int_property(context, "", "Left", "video\0pal\0overscan\0left\0", 13, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2033 settings_int_property(context, "", "Right", "video\0pal\0overscan\0right\0", 14, 0, 32); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2034 |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2035 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2036 pop_view(); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2037 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2038 nk_end(context); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2039 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2040 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2041 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2042 void view_audio_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2043 { |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2044 const char *rates[] = { |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2045 "192000", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2046 "96000", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2047 "48000", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2048 "44100", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2049 "22050" |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2050 }; |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2051 const char *sizes[] = { |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2052 "1024", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2053 "512", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2054 "256", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2055 "128", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2056 "64" |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2057 }; |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2058 const char *dac[] = { |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2059 "zero_offset", |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2060 "linear" |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2061 }; |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2062 const char *dac_desc[] = { |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2063 "Zero Offset", |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2064 "Linear" |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2065 }; |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2066 const uint32_t num_rates = sizeof(rates)/sizeof(*rates); |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2067 const uint32_t num_sizes = sizeof(sizes)/sizeof(*sizes); |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2068 const uint32_t num_dacs = sizeof(dac)/sizeof(*dac); |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2069 static int32_t selected_rate = -1; |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2070 static int32_t selected_size = -1; |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2071 static int32_t selected_dac = -1; |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2072 if (selected_rate < 0 || selected_size < 0 || selected_dac < 0) { |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
2073 selected_rate = find_match(rates, num_rates, "autio\0rate\0", "48000"); |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
2074 selected_size = find_match(sizes, num_sizes, "audio\0buffer\0", "512"); |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2075 selected_dac = find_match(dac, num_dacs, "audio\0fm_dac\0", "zero_offset"); |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2076 } |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2077 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2078 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2079 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2080 if (desired_width > width) { |
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2081 desired_width = width; |
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2082 } |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2083 if (nk_begin(context, "Audio Settings", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2084 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height , desired_width, 2); |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
2085 selected_rate = settings_dropdown(context, "Rate in Hz", rates, num_rates, selected_rate, "audio\0rate\0"); |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
2086 selected_size = settings_dropdown(context, "Buffer Samples", sizes, num_sizes, selected_size, "audio\0buffer\0"); |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2087 settings_int_input(context, "Lowpass Cutoff Hz", "audio\0lowpass_cutoff\0", "3390"); |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2088 settings_float_property(context, "Gain (dB)", "Overall", "audio\0gain\0", 0, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
1796
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
2089 settings_float_property(context, "", "FM", "audio\0fm_gain\0", 0, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
2090 settings_float_property(context, "", "PSG", "audio\0psg_gain\0", 0, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
2277
9e578fd493e1
Implement gain control for Ricoh PCM and CDDA with defaults based on Model 2 Sega CD
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2247
diff
changeset
|
2091 settings_float_property(context, "", "RF5C164", "audio\0rf5c164_gain\0", -6.0f, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
9e578fd493e1
Implement gain control for Ricoh PCM and CDDA with defaults based on Model 2 Sega CD
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2247
diff
changeset
|
2092 settings_float_property(context, "", "CDDA", "audio\0cdd_gain\0", -9.5f, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2093 selected_dac = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "FM DAC", dac, dac_desc, num_dacs, selected_dac, "audio\0fm_dac\0"); |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2094 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2095 pop_view(); |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2096 } |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2097 nk_end(context); |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2098 } |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2099 } |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2100 typedef struct { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2101 const char **models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2102 const char **names; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2103 uint32_t num_models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2104 uint32_t storage; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2105 uint8_t genesis_only; |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2106 } model_foreach_state; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2107 void model_iter(char *key, tern_val val, uint8_t valtype, void *data) |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2108 { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2109 if (valtype != TVAL_NODE) { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2110 return; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2111 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2112 if (!strcmp(tern_find_ptr_default(val.ptrval, "show", "yes"), "no")) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2113 return; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2114 } |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2115 model_foreach_state *state = data; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2116 if (state->genesis_only && strcmp(tern_find_ptr_default(val.ptrval, "vdp", "genesis"), "genesis")) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2117 return; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2118 } |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2119 if (state->num_models == state->storage) { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2120 state->storage *= 2; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2121 state->models = realloc(state->models, state->storage * sizeof(char *)); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2122 state->names = realloc(state->names, state->storage * sizeof(char *)); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2123 } |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2124 char *def = strdup(key); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2125 state->models[state->num_models] = def; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2126 state->names[state->num_models++] = tern_find_ptr_default(val.ptrval, "name", def); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2127 } |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2128 |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2129 typedef struct { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2130 const char **models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2131 const char **names; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2132 } models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2133 |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2134 models get_models(uint32_t *num_out, uint8_t genesis_only) |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2135 { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2136 tern_node *systems = get_systems_config(); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2137 model_foreach_state state = { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2138 .models = calloc(4, sizeof(char *)), |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2139 .names = calloc(4, sizeof(char *)), |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2140 .num_models = 0, |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2141 .storage = 4, |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2142 .genesis_only = genesis_only |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2143 }; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2144 tern_foreach(systems, model_iter, &state); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2145 *num_out = state.num_models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2146 return (models){ |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2147 .models = state.models, |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2148 .names = state.names |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2149 }; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2150 } |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2151 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2152 void view_system_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2153 { |
1568
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2154 const char *sync_opts[] = { |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2155 "video", |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2156 "audio" |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2157 }; |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2158 const uint32_t num_sync_opts = sizeof(sync_opts)/sizeof(*sync_opts); |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2159 static int32_t selected_sync = -1; |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2160 if (selected_sync < 0) { |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2161 selected_sync = find_match(sync_opts, num_sync_opts, "system\0sync_source\0", "video"); |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2162 } |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2163 const char *regions[] = { |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2164 "J - Japan", |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2165 "U - Americas", |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2166 "E - Europe" |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2167 }; |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2168 const char *region_codes[] = {"J", "U", "E"}; |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2169 const uint32_t num_regions = sizeof(regions)/sizeof(*regions); |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2170 static int32_t selected_region = -1; |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2171 if (selected_region < 0) { |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2172 selected_region = find_match(region_codes, num_regions, "system\0default_region\0", "U"); |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2173 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2174 static const char **model_opts, **sms_model_opts; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2175 static const char **model_names, **sms_model_names; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2176 static uint32_t num_models, num_sms_models; |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2177 if (!model_opts) { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2178 models m = get_models(&num_models, 1); |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2179 model_opts = m.models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2180 model_names = m.names; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2181 m = get_models(&num_sms_models, 0); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2182 sms_model_opts = m.models; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2183 sms_model_names = m.names; |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2184 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2185 static uint8_t old_show_sms; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2186 uint8_t show_sms = current_system && current_system->type == SYSTEM_SMS; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2187 |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2188 static int32_t selected_model = -1; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2189 if (selected_model < 0 || show_sms != old_show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2190 if (show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2191 selected_model = find_match(sms_model_opts, num_sms_models, "sms\0system\0model\0", "md1va3"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2192 } else { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2193 selected_model = find_match(model_opts, num_models, "system\0model\0", "md1va3"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2194 } |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2195 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2196 |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2197 static const char *formats[] = { |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2198 "native", |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2199 "gst" |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2200 }; |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2201 const uint32_t num_formats = sizeof(formats)/sizeof(*formats); |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2202 static int32_t selected_format = -1; |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2203 if (selected_format < 0) { |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2204 selected_format = find_match(formats, num_formats, "ui\0state_format\0", "native"); |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2205 } |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2206 static const char *ram_inits[] = { |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2207 "zero", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2208 "random" |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2209 }; |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2210 const uint32_t num_inits = sizeof(ram_inits)/sizeof(*ram_inits); |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2211 static int32_t selected_init = -1; |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2212 if (selected_init < 0) { |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2213 selected_init = find_match(ram_inits, num_inits, "system\0ram_init\0", "zero"); |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2214 } |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2215 static const char *io_opts_1[] = { |
1789
b3eb74936f18
Fix off by one in IO device UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1693
diff
changeset
|
2216 "none", |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2217 "gamepad2.1", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2218 "gamepad3.1", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2219 "gamepad6.1", |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2220 "sega_multitap.1", |
2238
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2221 "ea_multitap_port_a", |
1575
ccb3a8ae7ad0
Fix config value set when "Mega Mouse" is selected in settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1573
diff
changeset
|
2222 "mouse.1", |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2223 "saturn keyboard", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2224 "xband keyboard" |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2225 }; |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2226 static const char *io_opts_2[] = { |
1789
b3eb74936f18
Fix off by one in IO device UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1693
diff
changeset
|
2227 "none", |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2228 "gamepad2.2", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2229 "gamepad3.2", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2230 "gamepad6.2", |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2231 "sega_multitap.1", |
2238
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2232 "ea_multitap_port_b", |
1575
ccb3a8ae7ad0
Fix config value set when "Mega Mouse" is selected in settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1573
diff
changeset
|
2233 "mouse.1", |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2234 "saturn keyboard", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2235 "xband keyboard" |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2236 }; |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2237 static const char *type_names[sizeof(io_opts_1)/sizeof(*io_opts_1)]; |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2238 static int32_t selected_io_1 = -1; |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2239 static int32_t selected_io_2 = -1; |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2240 const uint32_t num_io = sizeof(io_opts_1)/sizeof(*io_opts_1); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2241 if (selected_io_1 < 0 || selected_io_2 < 0 || show_sms != old_show_sms) { |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2242 type_names[0] = device_type_names[IO_NONE]; |
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2243 type_names[1] = device_type_names[IO_GAMEPAD2]; |
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2244 type_names[2] = device_type_names[IO_GAMEPAD3]; |
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2245 type_names[3] = device_type_names[IO_GAMEPAD6]; |
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2246 type_names[4] = device_type_names[IO_SEGA_MULTI]; |
2238
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2247 type_names[5] = device_type_names[IO_EA_MULTI_A]; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2248 type_names[6] = device_type_names[IO_MOUSE]; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2249 type_names[7] = device_type_names[IO_SATURN_KEYBOARD]; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2250 type_names[8] = device_type_names[IO_XBAND_KEYBOARD]; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2251 if (show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2252 selected_io_1 = find_match(io_opts_1, num_io, "sms\0io\0devices\0""1\0", "gamepad2.1"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2253 selected_io_2 = find_match(io_opts_2, num_io, "sms\0io\0devices\0""2\0", "gamepad2.2"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2254 } else { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2255 selected_io_1 = find_match(io_opts_1, num_io, "io\0devices\0""1\0", "gamepad6.1"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2256 selected_io_2 = find_match(io_opts_2, num_io, "io\0devices\0""2\0", "gamepad6.2"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2257 } |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2258 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2259 old_show_sms = show_sms; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2260 |
1498
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2261 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2262 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2263 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
1498
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2264 if (nk_begin(context, "System Settings", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2265 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, desired_width, 2); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2266 |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2267 if (show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2268 selected_model = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "Model", sms_model_opts, sms_model_names, num_sms_models, selected_model, "sms\0system\0model\0"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2269 } else { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2270 selected_model = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "Model", model_opts, model_names, num_models, selected_model, "system\0model\0"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2271 } |
2238
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2272 int32_t old_selected = selected_io_1; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2273 char *config_path1, *config_path2; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2274 if (show_sms) { |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2275 config_path1 = "sms\0io\0devices\0""1\0"; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2276 config_path2 = "sms\0io\0devices\0""2\0"; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2277 } else { |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2278 config_path1 = "io\0devices\0""1\0"; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2279 config_path2 = "io\0devices\0""2\0"; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2280 } |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2281 selected_io_1 = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "IO Port 1 Device", io_opts_1, type_names, num_io, selected_io_1, config_path1); |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2282 if (old_selected != selected_io_1 && selected_io_1 != selected_io_2 && !strcmp(io_opts_1[selected_io_1], "ea_multitap_port_a")) { |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2283 selected_io_2 = selected_io_1; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2284 config = tern_insert_path(config, config_path2, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(io_opts_2[selected_io_2])}, TVAL_PTR); |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2285 } |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2286 old_selected = selected_io_2; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2287 selected_io_2 = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "IO Port 2 Device", io_opts_2, type_names, num_io, selected_io_2, config_path2); |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2288 if (old_selected != selected_io_2 && selected_io_1 != selected_io_2 && !strcmp(io_opts_2[selected_io_2], "ea_multitap_port_b")) { |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2289 selected_io_1 = selected_io_2; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2290 config = tern_insert_path(config, config_path1, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(io_opts_1[selected_io_1])}, TVAL_PTR); |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2291 } |
2014
9ca255be938d
Reorder system settings so that more common options are near the top and none of the dropdowns get cut off
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2003
diff
changeset
|
2292 selected_region = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "Default Region", region_codes, regions, num_regions, selected_region, "system\0default_region\0"); |
1568
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2293 selected_sync = settings_dropdown(context, "Sync Source", sync_opts, num_sync_opts, selected_sync, "system\0sync_source\0"); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2294 if (!show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2295 settings_int_property(context, "68000 Clock Divider", "", "clocks\0m68k_divider\0", 7, 1, 53); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2296 selected_format = settings_dropdown(context, "Save State Format", formats, num_formats, selected_format, "ui\0state_format\0"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2297 } |
2014
9ca255be938d
Reorder system settings so that more common options are near the top and none of the dropdowns get cut off
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2003
diff
changeset
|
2298 selected_init = settings_dropdown(context, "Initial RAM Value", ram_inits, num_inits, selected_init, "system\0ram_init\0"); |
1498
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2299 settings_toggle(context, "Remember ROM Path", "ui\0remember_path\0", 1); |
2355
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
2300 settings_toggle(context, "Use Native File Picker", "ui\0use_native_filechooser\0", 0); |
1852
a4cae960fd08
Allow config file to be saved with executable for "portable" setups
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1841
diff
changeset
|
2301 settings_toggle(context, "Save config with EXE", "ui\0config_in_exe_dir\0", 0); |
1853
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
2302 settings_string(context, "Game Save Path", "ui\0save_path\0", "$USERDATA/blastem/$ROMNAME"); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2303 |
1498
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2304 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
2355
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
2305 if (config_dirty) { |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
2306 char *unf = tern_find_path(config, "ui\0use_native_filechooser\0", TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
2307 use_native_filechooser = unf && !strcmp(unf, "on"); |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
2308 } |
1498
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2309 pop_view(); |
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2310 } |
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2311 nk_end(context); |
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2312 } |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2313 } |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2314 |
2018
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2315 void view_confirm_reset(struct nk_context *context) |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2316 { |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2317 if (nk_begin(context, "Reset Confirm", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2318 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 20; |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2319 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, desired_width, 1); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2320 nk_label(context, "This will reset all settings and controller", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2321 nk_label(context, "mappings back to the defaults.", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2322 nk_label(context, "Are you sure you want to proceed?", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2323 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.5, desired_width / 2, 2); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2324 if (nk_button_label(context, "Maybe not")) { |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2325 pop_view(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2326 } |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2327 if (nk_button_label(context, "Yep, delete it all")) { |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2328 delete_custom_config(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2329 config = load_config(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2330 delete_controller_info(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2331 config_dirty = 1; |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2332 pop_view(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2333 } |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2334 nk_end(context); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2335 } |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2336 } |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2337 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2338 void view_bios_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2339 { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2340 if (nk_begin(context, "Firmware", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2341 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
2369
3e064001594a
Better spacing in firmware settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2355
diff
changeset
|
2342 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.25f, desired_width, 2); |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2343 static const char* exts[] = {"md", "bin", "smd"}; |
2247
08a16de0e4cb
Fix settings save path of TMSS ROM setting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2238
diff
changeset
|
2344 settings_path(context, "TMSS ROM", "system\0tmss_path\0", "tmss.md", exts, 3); |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2345 settings_path(context, "US CD BIOS", "system\0scd_bios_us\0", "cdbios.md", exts, 3); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2346 settings_path(context, "JP CD BIOS", "system\0scd_bios_jp\0", "cdbios.md", exts, 3); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2347 settings_path(context, "EU CD BIOS", "system\0scd_bios_eu\0", "cdbios.md", exts, 3); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2348 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2349 pop_view(); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2350 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2351 nk_end(context); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2352 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2353 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2354 |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2355 void view_back(struct nk_context *context) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2356 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2357 pop_view(); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2358 pop_view(); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2359 current_view(context); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2360 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2361 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2362 void view_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2363 { |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2364 static menu_item items[] = { |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2365 {"Key Bindings", view_key_bindings}, |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2366 {"Controllers", view_controllers}, |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2367 {"Video", view_video_settings}, |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2368 {"Audio", view_audio_settings}, |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2369 {"System", view_system_settings}, |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2370 {"Firmware", view_bios_settings}, |
2018
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2371 {"Reset to Defaults", view_confirm_reset}, |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2372 {"Back", view_back} |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2373 }; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2374 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2375 if (nk_begin(context, "Settings Menu", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2376 menu(context, sizeof(items)/sizeof(*items), items, NULL); |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2377 nk_end(context); |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2378 } |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2379 } |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2380 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2381 void exit_handler(uint32_t index) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2382 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2383 exit(0); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2384 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2385 |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2386 void view_pause(struct nk_context *context) |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2387 { |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2388 static menu_item items[] = { |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2389 {"Resume", view_play}, |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2390 {"Load ROM", view_load}, |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
2391 {"Lock On", view_lock_on}, |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2392 {"Save State", view_save_state}, |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2393 {"Load State", view_load_state}, |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2394 {"Settings", view_settings}, |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2395 {"Exit", NULL} |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2396 }; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2397 |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2398 if (nk_begin(context, "Main Menu", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2399 menu(context, sizeof(items)/sizeof(*items), items, exit_handler); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2400 nk_end(context); |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2401 } |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2402 } |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2403 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2404 void view_menu(struct nk_context *context) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2405 { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2406 static menu_item items[] = { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2407 {"Load ROM", view_load}, |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2408 {"Settings", view_settings}, |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2409 {"About", view_about}, |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2410 {"Exit", NULL} |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2411 }; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2412 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2413 if (nk_begin(context, "Main Menu", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2414 menu(context, sizeof(items)/sizeof(*items), items, exit_handler); |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2415 nk_end(context); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2416 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2417 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2418 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2419 void blastem_nuklear_render(void) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2420 { |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2421 if (current_view != view_play) { |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2422 nk_input_end(context); |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2423 current_view(context); |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2424 if (fb_context) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2425 fb_context->fb.pixels = render_get_framebuffer(FRAMEBUFFER_UI, &fb_context->fb.pitch); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2426 nk_rawfb_render(fb_context, nk_rgb(0,0,0), 0); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2427 render_framebuffer_updated(FRAMEBUFFER_UI, render_width()); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2428 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2429 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2430 nk_sdl_render(NK_ANTI_ALIASING_ON, 512 * 1024, 128 * 1024); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2431 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2432 } |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2433 nk_input_begin(context); |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2434 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2435 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2436 |
1486
a6881d0d76d0
Pause game execution when in the new UI pause menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1485
diff
changeset
|
2437 void ui_idle_loop(void) |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2438 { |
1862
e07fc3d473b2
Basic UI navigation with controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1859
diff
changeset
|
2439 render_enable_gamepad_events(1); |
1482
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2440 const uint32_t MIN_UI_DELAY = 15; |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2441 static uint32_t last; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2442 while (current_view != view_play) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2443 { |
1482
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2444 uint32_t current = render_elapsed_ms(); |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2445 if ((current - last) < MIN_UI_DELAY) { |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2446 render_sleep_ms(MIN_UI_DELAY - (current - last) - 1); |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2447 } |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2448 last = current; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2449 render_update_display(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2450 } |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2451 if (config_dirty) { |
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2452 apply_updated_config(); |
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2453 persist_config(config); |
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2454 config_dirty = 0; |
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2455 } |
1862
e07fc3d473b2
Basic UI navigation with controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1859
diff
changeset
|
2456 render_enable_gamepad_events(0); |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2457 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2458 static void handle_event(SDL_Event *event) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2459 { |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
2460 if (event->type == SDL_KEYDOWN) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
2461 keycode = event->key.keysym.sym; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
2462 } |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2463 else if (event->type == SDL_JOYBUTTONDOWN) { |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2464 button_pressed = event->jbutton.button; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2465 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2466 else if (event->type == SDL_JOYHATMOTION) { |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2467 hat_moved = event->jhat.hat; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2468 hat_value = event->jhat.value; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2469 } |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2470 else if (event->type == SDL_JOYAXISMOTION) { |
2319
ab3d8759da08
Slightly more reasonable threshold value for axes during mapping. Still pretty broken though
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
2471 if (event->jaxis.axis == axis_moved || abs(event->jaxis.value) > abs(axis_value) || abs(event->jaxis.value) > 4000) { |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2472 axis_moved = event->jaxis.axis; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2473 axis_value = event->jaxis.value; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2474 } |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2475 } else if (event->type == SDL_MOUSEBUTTONDOWN && event->button.button == 0) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2476 click = 1; |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2477 } else if (event->type == SDL_MOUSEBUTTONUP && event->button.button == 0) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2478 click = 0; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2479 } |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
2480 if (stick_nav_disabled && event->type == SDL_CONTROLLERAXISMOTION) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
2481 return; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
2482 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2483 nk_sdl_handle_event(event); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2484 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2485 |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2486 static void context_destroyed(void) |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2487 { |
1681
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2488 if (context) |
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2489 { |
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2490 nk_sdl_shutdown(); |
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2491 context = NULL; |
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2492 } |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2493 } |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2494 |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2495 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
1609
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2496 static struct nk_image load_image_texture(uint32_t *buf, uint32_t width, uint32_t height) |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2497 { |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2498 GLuint tex; |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2499 glGenTextures(1, &tex); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2500 glBindTexture(GL_TEXTURE_2D, tex); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2501 glTexParameterf(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_MIN_FILTER, GL_LINEAR); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2502 glTexParameterf(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_MAG_FILTER, GL_LINEAR); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2503 glTexParameterf(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_WRAP_S, GL_CLAMP_TO_EDGE); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2504 glTexParameterf(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_WRAP_T, GL_CLAMP_TO_EDGE); |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2505 #ifdef USE_GLES |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2506 glTexImage2D(GL_TEXTURE_2D, 0, GL_RGBA, width, height, 0, GL_RGBA, GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE, buf); |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2507 #else |
1609
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2508 glTexImage2D(GL_TEXTURE_2D, 0, GL_RGBA8, width, height, 0, GL_BGRA, GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE, buf); |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2509 #endif |
1609
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2510 return nk_image_id((int)tex); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2511 } |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2512 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2513 |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2514 static struct nk_image load_image_rawfb(uint32_t *buf, uint32_t width, uint32_t height) |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2515 { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2516 struct rawfb_image *fbimg = calloc(1, sizeof(struct rawfb_image)); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2517 fbimg->pixels = buf; |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2518 fbimg->pitch = width * sizeof(uint32_t); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2519 fbimg->w = width; |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2520 fbimg->h = height; |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2521 fbimg->format = NK_FONT_ATLAS_RGBA32; |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2522 return nk_image_ptr(fbimg); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2523 } |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2524 |
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2525 static void texture_init(void) |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2526 { |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2527 struct nk_font_atlas *atlas; |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2528 if (fb_context) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2529 nk_rawfb_font_stash_begin(fb_context, &atlas); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2530 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2531 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2532 nk_sdl_font_stash_begin(&atlas); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2533 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2534 } |
1527
4f6e8acd7b6a
Added support for TTC and dfont format true type fonts. More robust font selection on Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1526
diff
changeset
|
2535 uint32_t font_size; |
4f6e8acd7b6a
Added support for TTC and dfont format true type fonts. More robust font selection on Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1526
diff
changeset
|
2536 uint8_t *font = default_font(&font_size); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2537 if (!font) { |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2538 fatal_error("Failed to find default font path\n"); |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2539 } |
2294
7e995fb948c3
Make UI font less comically large
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2277
diff
changeset
|
2540 def_font = nk_font_atlas_add_from_memory(atlas, font, font_size, render_height() / 24, NULL); |
1593
24508cb54f87
Fix a number of other memory errors (mostly leaks again) identified by valgrind
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1581
diff
changeset
|
2541 free(font); |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2542 if (fb_context) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2543 nk_rawfb_font_stash_end(fb_context); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2544 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2545 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2546 nk_sdl_font_stash_end(); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2547 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2548 } |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2549 nk_style_set_font(context, &def_font->handle); |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2550 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_ui_images; i++) |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2551 { |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2552 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2553 if (fb_context) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2554 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2555 ui_images[i]->ui = load_image_rawfb(ui_images[i]->image_data, ui_images[i]->width, ui_images[i]->height); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2556 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2557 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2558 ui_images[i]->ui = load_image_texture(ui_images[i]->image_data, ui_images[i]->width, ui_images[i]->height); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2559 } |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2560 #endif |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2561 } |
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2562 } |
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2563 |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2564 static void style_init(void) |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2565 { |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2566 context->style.checkbox.padding.x = render_height() / 120; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2567 context->style.checkbox.padding.y = render_height() / 120; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2568 context->style.checkbox.border = render_height() / 240; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2569 context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.type = NK_STYLE_ITEM_COLOR; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2570 context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color = (struct nk_color){ |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2571 .r = 255, .g = 128, .b = 0, .a = 255 |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2572 }; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2573 context->style.checkbox.cursor_hover = context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal; |
1854
58b6f5d918f4
Minor improvements to keyboard navigation
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1853
diff
changeset
|
2574 context->style.property.inc_button.text_hover = (struct nk_color){ |
58b6f5d918f4
Minor improvements to keyboard navigation
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1853
diff
changeset
|
2575 .r = 255, .g = 128, .b = 0, .a = 255 |
58b6f5d918f4
Minor improvements to keyboard navigation
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1853
diff
changeset
|
2576 }; |
58b6f5d918f4
Minor improvements to keyboard navigation
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1853
diff
changeset
|
2577 context->style.property.dec_button.text_hover = context->style.property.inc_button.text_hover; |
1855
92532eb6986d
Make combo boxes keyboard navigable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1854
diff
changeset
|
2578 context->style.combo.button.text_hover = context->style.property.inc_button.text_hover; |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2579 } |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2580 |
2308
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2581 static void fb_resize(void) |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2582 { |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2583 nk_rawfb_resize_fb(fb_context, NULL, render_width(), render_height(), 0); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2584 style_init(); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2585 texture_init(); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2586 } |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2587 |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2588 static void context_created(void) |
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2589 { |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2590 context = nk_sdl_init(render_get_window()); |
2308
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2591 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2592 if (render_has_gl()) { |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2593 nk_sdl_device_create(); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2594 } else { |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2595 #endif |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2596 fb_context = nk_rawfb_init(NULL, context, render_width(), render_height(), 0); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2597 render_set_ui_fb_resize_handler(fb_resize); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2598 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2599 } |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2600 #endif |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2601 style_init(); |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2602 texture_init(); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2603 } |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2604 |
1477
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2605 void show_pause_menu(void) |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2606 { |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2607 if (current_view == view_play) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2608 set_content_binding_state(0); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2609 context->style.window.background = nk_rgba(0, 0, 0, 128); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2610 context->style.window.fixed_background = nk_style_item_color(nk_rgba(0, 0, 0, 128)); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2611 current_view = view_pause; |
1841
5d10b8494b02
WIP keyboard nav for Nuklear menus
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1831
diff
changeset
|
2612 context->input.selected_widget = 0; |
1980
81df9aa2de9b
Less hacky run on audio thread mode
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1910
diff
changeset
|
2613 system_request_exit(current_system, 1); |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2614 } else if (current_system && !set_binding) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2615 clear_view_stack(); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2616 show_play_view(); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2617 } |
1477
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2618 } |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2619 |
1581
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2620 void show_play_view(void) |
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2621 { |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2622 set_content_binding_state(1); |
1581
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2623 current_view = view_play; |
1841
5d10b8494b02
WIP keyboard nav for Nuklear menus
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1831
diff
changeset
|
2624 context->input.selected_widget = 0; |
1581
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2625 } |
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2626 |
1477
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2627 static uint8_t active; |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2628 uint8_t is_nuklear_active(void) |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2629 { |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2630 return active; |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2631 } |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2632 |
1483
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2633 uint8_t is_nuklear_available(void) |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2634 { |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2635 /*if (!render_has_gl()) { |
1483
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2636 //currently no fallback if GL2 unavailable |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2637 return 0; |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2638 }*/ |
1483
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2639 char *style = tern_find_path(config, "ui\0style\0", TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2640 if (!style) { |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2641 return 1; |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2642 } |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2643 return strcmp(style, "rom") != 0; |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2644 } |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2645 |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2646 static void persist_config_exit(void) |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2647 { |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2648 if (config_dirty) { |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2649 persist_config(config); |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2650 } |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2651 } |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2652 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2653 ui_image *load_ui_image(char *name) |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2654 { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2655 uint32_t buf_size; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2656 uint8_t *buf = (uint8_t *)read_bundled_file(name, &buf_size); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2657 if (buf) { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2658 num_ui_images++; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2659 if (num_ui_images > ui_image_storage) { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2660 ui_image_storage = (ui_image_storage + 1) * 2; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2661 ui_images = realloc(ui_images, ui_image_storage * sizeof(*ui_images)); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2662 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2663 ui_image *this_image = ui_images[num_ui_images-1] = calloc(1, sizeof(ui_image)); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2664 this_image->image_data = load_png(buf, buf_size, &this_image->width, &this_image->height); |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2665 #ifdef USE_GLES |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2666 uint32_t *cur = this_image->image_data; |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2667 for (int i = 0; i < this_image->width*this_image->height; i++, cur++) |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2668 { |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2669 uint32_t pixel = *cur; |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2670 *cur = (pixel & 0xFF00FF00) | (pixel << 16 & 0xFF0000) | (pixel >> 16 & 0xFF); |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2671 } |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2672 #endif |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2673 free(buf); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2674 if (!this_image->image_data) { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2675 num_ui_images--; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2676 free(this_image); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2677 return NULL; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2678 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2679 return this_image; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2680 } else { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2681 return NULL; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2682 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2683 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2684 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2685 void blastem_nuklear_init(uint8_t file_loaded) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2686 { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2687 context = nk_sdl_init(render_get_window()); |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2688 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2689 if (render_has_gl()) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2690 nk_sdl_device_create(); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2691 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2692 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2693 fb_context = nk_rawfb_init(NULL, context, render_width(), render_height(), 0); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2694 render_set_ui_fb_resize_handler(fb_resize); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2695 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2696 } |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2697 #endif |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2698 style_init(); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2699 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2700 controller_360 = load_ui_image("images/360.png"); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2701 controller_ps4 = load_ui_image("images/ps4.png"); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2702 controller_ps4_6b = load_ui_image("images/ps4_6b.png"); |
2003
4c418ee9a9d8
Added Wii U controller image
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1980
diff
changeset
|
2703 controller_wiiu = load_ui_image("images/wiiu.png"); |
2020
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
2704 controller_gen_6b = load_ui_image("images/genesis_6b.png"); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2705 |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2706 texture_init(); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2707 |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2708 if (file_loaded) { |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2709 current_view = view_play; |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2710 } else { |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2711 current_view = view_menu; |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2712 set_content_binding_state(0); |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2713 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2714 render_set_ui_render_fun(blastem_nuklear_render); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2715 render_set_event_handler(handle_event); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2716 render_set_gl_context_handlers(context_destroyed, context_created); |
2355
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
2717 char *unf = tern_find_path(config, "ui\0use_native_filechooser\0", TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
94cf5cc89227
Add an option to use the system file picker on Linux and Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2319
diff
changeset
|
2718 use_native_filechooser = unf && !strcmp(unf, "on"); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2719 |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2720 atexit(persist_config_exit); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2721 |
1477
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2722 active = 1; |
1486
a6881d0d76d0
Pause game execution when in the new UI pause menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1485
diff
changeset
|
2723 ui_idle_loop(); |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2724 } |